D5600RM (En)01

D5600 - Reference Manual D5600RM_EN Free User Guide for Nikon D Series Camera, Manual - page3

User Manual: Nikon D5600 User Manual Pdf | User Manual PDF

Open the PDF directly: View PDF PDF.
Page Count: 424

DownloadD5600RM (En)01
Open PDF In BrowserView PDF
DIGITAL CAMERA

Reference Manual

• Read this manual thoroughly before using the camera.
• To ensure proper use of the camera, be sure to read
“For Your Safety” (page xiii).
• After reading this manual, keep it in a readily accessible
place for future reference.

En

Your images. The world. Connected
Welcome to SnapBridge — Nikon’s new family of services to enrich
your image experience. SnapBridge eliminates the barrier between
your camera and compatible smart device, through a combination
of Bluetooth® low energy (BLE) technology and a dedicated app. The
stories you capture with your Nikon camera and lenses are
automatically transferred to the device as they are taken. They can
even be uploaded effortlessly to cloud storage services, inviting
access across all your devices. You can share your excitement, when
and where you want.

Download the SnapBridge app to get started!
Take advantage of the wide-ranging
convenience by downloading the
SnapBridge app onto your smart device
now. Through a few simple steps, this app
connects your Nikon cameras with a
compatible iPhone®, iPad® and/or
iPod touch® or smart devices running on
the AndroidTM operating system. The app
is available free from the website
(http://snapbridge.nikon.com), Apple
App Store® and Google PlayTM.
For the latest information on SnapBridge, visit the Nikon website for your
area (0 xxi).
D5600 Model Name: N1538

The exciting image experience that SnapBridge offers…
Automatic picture transfer from camera to smart
device thanks to the constant connection between
the two devices — making online photo sharing
easier than ever
Upload of photos and thumbnail images to the
NIKON IMAGE SPACE cloud service

A range of services that enriches your imaging life,
including:
• Camera remote control

• Imprinting up to two pieces of credit
information (e.g. copyright, comments,
text and logos) on pictures

Nikon D5600, AF-P DX NIKKOR 18–55mm f/3.5–5.6G VR

• Automatic update of camera’s date and
time info and location info

• Receive camera’s firmware updates

i

To get the most from your camera, please be sure to read all
instructions thoroughly and keep them where they will be read
by all who use the product.
Symbols and Conventions
To make it easier to find the information you need, the following
symbols and conventions are used:

D

This icon marks cautions; information that should be
read before use to prevent damage to the camera.

A

This icon marks notes; information that should be read
before using the camera.

0

This icon marks references to other pages in this
manual.

Menu items, options, and messages displayed in the camera monitor are
shown in bold.
Camera Settings
The explanations in this manual assume that default settings are used.
Nikon Manual Viewer 2
Install the Nikon Manual Viewer 2 app on your smartphone or
tablet to view Nikon digital camera manuals, anytime,
anywhere. Nikon Manual Viewer 2 can be downloaded free of
charge from the App Store and Google Play. Download of the
app and any product manuals requires an Internet
connection, for which fees may be levied by your phone or
Internet service provider.
A For Your Safety
Before using the camera for the first time, read the safety instructions
in “For Your Safety” (0 xiii–xvi).

ii

Table of Contents
For Your Safety........................................................................... xiii
Notices........................................................................................ xvii
Bluetooth and Wi-Fi (Wireless LAN)...................................... xxii
Introduction

1

Getting to Know the Camera...................................................... 1
The Camera Body .................................................................................. 1
The Mode Dial ........................................................................................ 4
The Viewfinder ....................................................................................... 5
The R (Info) Button.............................................................................. 6
The P Button ......................................................................................... 12
The Monitor ................................................................................. 13
Using the Touch Screen.................................................................... 15
Touch-Screen Photography ............................................................ 17
Viewing Pictures .................................................................................. 23
Using the Menus.................................................................................. 25
First Steps

26

Attach the Camera Strap .................................................................. 26
Charge the Battery.............................................................................. 26
Insert the Battery and a Memory Card......................................... 27
Open the Monitor ............................................................................... 29
Attach a Lens ........................................................................................ 30
Camera Setup ....................................................................................... 33
Focus the Viewfinder ......................................................................... 41
Tutorial

42

Camera Menus: An Overview ................................................... 42
The Battery Level and Number of Exposures Remaining ... 46

iii

Basic Photography and Playback

47

“Point-and-Shoot” Modes (i and j)..................................... 47
Basic Playback............................................................................. 56
Deleting Unwanted Photographs................................................. 57
Matching Settings to the Subject or Situation
(Scene Mode)

58

k Portrait........................................................................................ 59
l Landscape ................................................................................. 59
p Child ............................................................................................ 59
m Sports .......................................................................................... 60
n Close up...................................................................................... 60
o Night Portrait............................................................................ 60
r Night Landscape ..................................................................... 61
s Party/Indoor ............................................................................. 61
t Beach/Snow.............................................................................. 61
u Sunset ......................................................................................... 62
v Dusk/Dawn ............................................................................... 62
w Pet Portrait ................................................................................ 62
x Candlelight ................................................................................. 63
y Blossom ...................................................................................... 63
z Autumn Colors......................................................................... 63
0 Food.............................................................................................. 64

iv

Special Effects
% Night Vision..............................................................................
S Super Vivid ................................................................................
T Pop ............................................................................................
U Photo Illustration....................................................................
' Toy Camera Effect ..................................................................
( Miniature Effect ......................................................................
3 Selective Color ........................................................................
1 Silhouette..................................................................................
2 High Key ....................................................................................
3 Low Key......................................................................................
Options Available in Live View ......................................................
More on Photography

65
65
66
66
66
67
67
67
68
68
68
70
75

Choosing a Release Mode......................................................... 75
Continuous Shooting (Burst Mode)........................................ 76
Quiet Shutter Release................................................................ 78
Self-Timer Mode ......................................................................... 79
Focus............................................................................................. 82
Focus Mode .......................................................................................... 82
AF-Area Mode ...................................................................................... 87
Focus Lock............................................................................................. 93
Manual Focus ....................................................................................... 95
Image Quality and Size ............................................................. 98
Image Quality....................................................................................... 98
Image Size ........................................................................................... 100
Using the Built-in Flash ........................................................... 101
Auto Pop-up Modes......................................................................... 101
Manual Pop-up Modes ................................................................... 103
ISO Sensitivity ........................................................................... 107
Interval Timer Photography................................................... 109
Restoring Default Settings ..................................................... 115
v

P, S, A, and M Modes

118

Shutter Speed and Aperture ................................................. 118
Mode P (Programmed Auto) ........................................................ 119
Mode S (Shutter-Priority Auto) .................................................... 121
Mode A (Aperture-Priority Auto)................................................. 122
Mode M (Manual).............................................................................. 123
Long Time-Exposures (M Mode Only) ....................................... 125
Exposure.................................................................................... 128
Metering .............................................................................................. 128
Autoexposure Lock.......................................................................... 130
Exposure Compensation ............................................................... 132
Flash Compensation ....................................................................... 134
Preserving Detail in Highlights and Shadows.................... 136
Active D-Lighting ............................................................................. 136
High Dynamic Range (HDR) ......................................................... 138
White Balance........................................................................... 140
Fine-Tuning White Balance .......................................................... 143
Preset Manual.................................................................................... 145
Bracketing................................................................................. 151
Picture Controls ....................................................................... 155
Selecting a Picture Control ........................................................... 155
Modifying Picture Controls........................................................... 157
Creating Custom Picture Controls ............................................. 161

vi

Recording and Viewing Movies

164

Recording Movies .................................................................... 164
The P Button....................................................................................... 166
Movie Settings ................................................................................... 168
Time-Lapse Movies .................................................................. 171
Viewing Movies ........................................................................ 176
Editing Movies .......................................................................... 178
Trimming Movies.............................................................................. 178
Saving Selected Frames ................................................................. 182
Playback and Deletion

184

Full-Frame Playback ................................................................ 184
Thumbnail Playback ........................................................................ 185
Calendar Playback ............................................................................ 186
The P Button....................................................................................... 187
Photo Information ................................................................... 188
Taking a Closer Look: Playback Zoom.................................. 196
Protecting Photographs from Deletion ............................... 200
Rating Pictures.......................................................................... 201
Rating Individual Pictures.............................................................. 201
Rating Multiple Pictures ................................................................. 202
Selecting Photos for Upload .................................................. 203
Selecting Individual Photos .......................................................... 203
Selecting Multiple Photos ............................................................. 204
Deleting Photographs............................................................. 205
During Playback ................................................................................ 205
The Playback Menu.......................................................................... 206
Slide Shows ............................................................................... 208
Slide Show Options.......................................................................... 209

vii

Connections

210

Installing ViewNX-i.................................................................. 210
Copying Pictures to the Computer ...................................... 211
Printing Photographs ............................................................. 214
Connecting the Printer................................................................... 214
Printing Pictures One at a Time................................................... 215
Printing Multiple Pictures.............................................................. 216
Viewing Pictures on TV........................................................... 218
Camera Menus

220

D The Playback Menu: Managing Images ................................ 220
Playback Menu Options................................................................. 220
Playback Folder ......................................................................... 221
Playback Display Options ...................................................... 221
Image Review............................................................................. 221
Auto Image Rotation ............................................................... 222
Rotate Tall.................................................................................... 222
C The Shooting Menu: Shooting Options................................. 223
Shooting Menu Options ................................................................ 223
Reset Shooting Menu.............................................................. 225
Storage Folder ........................................................................... 225
File Naming................................................................................. 227
NEF (RAW) Recording .............................................................. 227
ISO Sensitivity Settings ........................................................... 228
Color Space ................................................................................. 230
Long Exposure NR .................................................................... 230
High ISO NR................................................................................. 231
Vignette Control........................................................................ 231
Auto Distortion Control.......................................................... 232
Optical VR .................................................................................... 232

viii

A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings........................ 233
Custom Settings................................................................................ 234
Reset Custom Settings ............................................................ 235
a: Autofocus ................................................................................... 235
a1: AF-C Priority Selection...................................................... 235
a2: Number of Focus Points................................................... 236
a3: Built-in AF-assist Illuminator .......................................... 237
a4: Rangefinder.......................................................................... 237
a5: Manual Focus Ring in AF Mode..................................... 238
b: Exposure..................................................................................... 239
b1: EV Steps for Exposure Cntrl............................................ 239
b2: ISO Display............................................................................ 239
c: Timers/AE Lock ......................................................................... 239
c1: Shutter-Release Button AE-L .......................................... 239
c2: Auto off Timers.................................................................... 240
c3: Self-Timer .............................................................................. 241
d: Shooting/Display..................................................................... 241
d1: Exposure Delay Mode....................................................... 241
d2: File Number Sequence..................................................... 242
d3: Viewfinder Grid Display ................................................... 243
d4: Date Stamp........................................................................... 243
d5: Reverse Indicators.............................................................. 245
e: Bracketing/Flash ...................................................................... 246
e1: Flash Cntrl for Built-in Flash/Optional Flash............. 246
e2: Auto Bracketing Set........................................................... 251
f: Controls........................................................................................ 252
f1: Assign Fn Button ................................................................. 252
f2: Assign AE-L/AF-L Button................................................... 254
f3: Assign Touch Fn................................................................... 255
f4: Reverse Dial Rotation......................................................... 256

ix

B The Setup Menu: Camera Setup .............................................. 257
Setup Menu Options....................................................................... 257
Format Memory Card .............................................................. 259
Image Comment ....................................................................... 260
Copyright Information............................................................ 261
Time Zone and Date ................................................................ 262
Language..................................................................................... 262
Beep Options.............................................................................. 263
Touch Controls .......................................................................... 263
Monitor Brightness................................................................... 263
Info Display Format.................................................................. 264
Auto Info Display ...................................................................... 265
Info Display Auto Off ............................................................... 265
Image Dust Off Ref Photo ...................................................... 266
Flicker Reduction ...................................................................... 268
Slot Empty Release Lock......................................................... 268
Location Data ............................................................................. 269
Remote Control ......................................................................... 270
Airplane Mode ........................................................................... 271
Connect to Smart Device ....................................................... 271
Send to Smart Device (Auto) ................................................ 272
Wi-Fi............................................................................................... 272
Bluetooth..................................................................................... 273
Eye-Fi Upload ............................................................................. 274
Conformity Marking................................................................. 276
Firmware Version...................................................................... 276

x

N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies....................... 277
Retouch Menu Options .................................................................. 277
Creating Retouched Copies .......................................................... 278
NEF (RAW) Processing ............................................................. 280
Trim ................................................................................................ 282
Resize............................................................................................. 283
D-Lighting.................................................................................... 285
Quick Retouch ............................................................................ 286
Red-Eye Correction................................................................... 286
Straighten .................................................................................... 287
Distortion Control ..................................................................... 287
Perspective Control .................................................................. 288
Fisheye .......................................................................................... 288
Filter Effects................................................................................. 289
Monochrome .............................................................................. 290
Image Overlay ............................................................................ 291
Color Outline............................................................................... 293
Photo Illustration....................................................................... 294
Color Sketch ................................................................................ 294
Miniature Effect.......................................................................... 295
Selective Color............................................................................ 296
Painting......................................................................................... 298
Side-by-side Comparison ....................................................... 298
m Recent Settings/O My Menu ............................................. 300
Choosing a Menu.............................................................................. 300
m Recent Settings ............................................................................ 301
O My Menu......................................................................................... 301

xi

Technical Notes

305

Compatible Lenses.................................................................. 305
Compatible CPU Lenses................................................................. 305
Compatible Non-CPU Lenses....................................................... 308
The Nikon Creative Lighting System (CLS) ......................... 315
Other Accessories .................................................................... 321
Attaching a Power Connector and AC Adapter .................... 325
Caring for the Camera ............................................................ 327
Storage................................................................................................. 327
Cleaning............................................................................................... 327
Image Sensor Cleaning .................................................................. 328
Caring for the Camera and Battery: Cautions .................... 333
Available Settings.................................................................... 338
Troubleshooting...................................................................... 340
Battery/Display.................................................................................. 340
Shooting (All Modes) ...................................................................... 341
Shooting (P, S, A, M)........................................................................... 345
Playback............................................................................................... 346
Bluetooth and Wi-Fi (Wireless Networks)................................ 348
Miscellaneous.................................................................................... 348
Error Messages......................................................................... 349
Specifications ........................................................................... 356
Lens Kits .................................................................................... 369
AF-P DX NIKKOR 18–55mm f/3.5–5.6G VR .............................. 369
AF-P DX NIKKOR 70–300mm f/4.5–6.3G ED VR and
AF-P DX NIKKOR 70–300mm f/4.5–6.3G ED....................... 375
AF-S DX NIKKOR 18–140mm f/3.5–5.6G ED VR ..................... 380
Memory Card Capacity ........................................................... 387
Battery Life................................................................................ 388
Index .......................................................................................... 390

xii

For Your Safety
To prevent damage to property or injury to yourself or to others, read “For
Your Safety” in its entirety before using this product.
Keep these safety instructions where all those who use this product will read
them.
DANGER: Failure to observe the precautions marked with this icon carries a
high risk of death or severe injury.
WARNING: Failure to observe the precautions marked with this icon could
result in death or severe injury.
CAUTION: Failure to observe the precautions marked with this icon could
result in injury or property damage.

WARNING
• Do not use while walking or operating a motor vehicle.
Failure to observe this precaution could result in accidents or other injury.
• Do not disassemble or modify this product. Do not touch internal parts
that become exposed as the result of a fall or other accident.
Failure to observe these precautions could result in electric shock or other
injury.
• Should you notice any abnormalities such as the product producing
smoke, heat, or unusual odors, immediately disconnect the battery or
power source.
Continued operation could result in fire, burns or other injury.
• Keep dry. Do not handle with wet hands. Do not handle the plug with
wet hands.
Failure to observe these precautions could result in fire or electric shock.
• Do not let your skin remain in prolonged contact with this product
while it is on or plugged in.
Failure to observe this precaution could result in low-temperature burns.
• Do not use this product in the presence of flammable dust or gas such
as propane, gasoline or aerosols.
Failure to observe this precaution could result in explosion or fire.

xiii

• Do not directly view the sun or other bright light source through the
lens or camera.
Failure to observe this precaution could result in visual impairment.
• Do not aim the flash or AF-assist illuminator at the operator of a motor
vehicle.
Failure to observe this precaution could result in accidents.
• Keep this product out of reach of children.
Failure to observe this precaution could result in injury or product
malfunction. In addition, note that small parts constitute a choking hazard.
Should a child swallow any part of this product, seek immediate medical
attention.
• Do not entangle, wrap or twist the straps around your neck.
Failure to observe this precaution could result in accidents.
• Do not use batteries, chargers, or AC adapters not specifically
designated for use with this product. When using batteries, chargers,
and AC adapters designated for use with this product, do not:
- Damage, modify, forcibly tug or bend the cords or cables, place them
under heavy objects, or expose them to heat or flame.
- Use travel converters or adapters designed to convert from one
voltage to another or with DC-to-AC inverters.
Failure to observe these precautions could result in fire or electric shock.
• Do not handle the plug when charging the product or using the AC
adapter during thunderstorms.
Failure to observe this precaution could result in electric shock.
• Do not handle with bare hands in locations exposed to extremely high
or low temperatures.
Failure to observe this precaution could result in burns, or frostbite.

CAUTION
• Do not leave the lens pointed at the sun or other strong light sources.
Light focused by the lens could cause fire or damage to product’s internal
parts. When shooting backlit subjects, keep the sun well out of the frame.
Sunlight focused into the camera when the sun is close to the frame could
cause fire.

xiv

• Turn this product off when its use is prohibited. Disable wireless
features when the use of wireless equipment is prohibited.
The radio-frequency emissions produced by this product could interfere
with equipment onboard aircraft or in hospitals or other medical facilities.
• Remove the battery and disconnect the AC adapter if this product will
not be used for an extended period.
Failure to observe this precaution could result in fire or product
malfunction.
• Do not touch moving parts of the lens or other moving parts.
Failure to observe this precaution could result in injury.
• Do not fire the flash in contact with or in close proximity to the skin or
objects.
Failure to observe this precaution could result in burns or fire.
• Do not leave the product where it will be exposed to extremely high
temperatures, for an extended period such as in an enclosed
automobile or in direct sunlight.
Failure to observe this precaution could result in fire or product
malfunction.

DANGER (Batteries)
• Do not mishandle batteries.
Failure to observe the following precautions could result in the batteries
leaking, overheating, rupturing, or catching fire:
- Use only rechargeable batteries approved for use in this product.
- Do not expose batteries to flame or excessive heat.
- Do not disassemble.
- Do not short-circuit the terminals by touching them to necklaces,
hairpins, or other metal objects.
- Do not expose batteries or the products in which they are inserted to
powerful physical shocks.
• Do not attempt to recharge EN-EL14a rechargeable batteries using
chargers not specifically designated for this purpose.
Failure to observe this precaution could result in the batteries leaking,
overheating, rupturing, or catching fire.
• If battery liquid comes into contact with the eyes, rinse with plenty of
clean water and seek immediate medical attention.
Delaying action could result in eye injuries.

xv

WARNING (Batteries)
• Keep batteries out of reach of children.
Should a child swallow a battery, seek immediate medical attention.
• Do not immerse batteries in water or expose to rain.
Failure to observe this precaution could result in fire or product
malfunction. Immediately dry the product with a towel or similar object
should it become wet.
• Discontinue use immediately should you notice any changes in the
batteries, such as discoloration or deformation. Cease charging
EN-EL14a rechargeable batteries if they do not charge in the specified
period of time.
Failure to observe these precautions could result in the batteries leaking,
overheating, rupturing, or catching fire.
• Prior to disposal, insulate battery terminals with tape.
Overheating, rupture, or fire may result should metal objects come into
contact with the terminals. Recycle or dispose of batteries in accord with
local regulations.
• If battery liquid comes into contact with a person's skin or clothing,
immediately rinse the affected area with plenty of clean water.
Failure to observe this precaution could result in skin irritation.

xvi

Notices
• No part of the manuals included
• Nikon will not be held liable for any
with this product may be
damages resulting from the use of
reproduced, transmitted,
this product.
transcribed, stored in a retrieval
• While every effort has been made to
system, or translated into any
ensure that the information in these
language in any form, by any means, manuals is accurate and complete,
without Nikon’s prior written
we would appreciate it were you to
permission.
bring any errors or omissions to the
• Nikon reserves the right to change
attention of the Nikon
the appearance and specifications
representative in your area (address
of the hardware and software
provided separately).
described in these manuals at any
time and without prior notice.

Notice for Customers in Canada
CAN ICES-3 B / NMB-3 B

Notices for Customers in Europe
CAUTION: RISK OF EXPLOSION IF BATTERY IS REPLACED BY AN INCORRECT
TYPE. DISPOSE OF USED BATTERIES ACCORDING TO THE INSTRUCTIONS.
This symbol indicates that
electrical and electronic
equipment is to be
collected separately.

This symbol on the battery
indicates that the battery
is to be collected
separately.

The following apply only
to users in European countries:
• This product is designated for
separate collection at an
appropriate collection point. Do not
dispose of as household waste.
• Separate collection and recycling
helps conserve natural resources
and prevent negative consequences
for human health and the
environment that might result from
incorrect disposal.
• For more information, contact the
retailer or the local authorities in
charge of waste management.

The following apply only to users in
European countries:
• All batteries, whether marked with
this symbol or not, are designated
for separate collection at an
appropriate collection point. Do not
dispose of as household waste.
• For more information, contact the
retailer or the local authorities in
charge of waste management.

xvii

Notices for Customers in the U.S.A.
The Battery Charger

IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS—SAVE THESE
INSTRUCTIONS
DANGER—TO REDUCE THE RISK OF FIRE OR ELECTRIC
SHOCK, CAREFULLY FOLLOW THESE INSTRUCTIONS
For connection to a supply not in the U.S.A., use an attachment plug adapter
of the proper configuration for the power outlet if needed. This power unit
is intended to be correctly oriented in a vertical or floor mount position.
Federal Communications Commission (FCC) Radio Frequency Interference Statement
This equipment has been tested and
found to comply with the limits for a
Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15
D5600
of the FCC rules. These limits are
designed to provide reasonable
CAUTIONS
protection against harmful interference Modifications
in a residential installation. This
The FCC requires the user be notified
equipment generates, uses, and can
that any changes or modifications
radiate radio frequency energy and, if
made to this device that are not
not installed and used in accordance
expressly approved by Nikon
with the instructions, may cause harmful
Corporation may void the user’s
interference to radio communications.
authority to operate the equipment.
However, there is no guarantee that
interference will not occur in a particular Interface Cables
Use the interface cables sold or
installation. If this equipment does
cause harmful interference to radio or provided by Nikon for your
equipment. Using other interface
television reception, which can be
determined by turning the equipment cables may exceed the limits of Class
off and on, the user is encouraged to try B Part 15 of the FCC rules.
to correct the interference by one or
Notice for Customers in the State
more of the following measures:
of California
• Reorient or relocate the receiving
WARNING: Handling the cord on this
antenna.
product may expose you to lead, a
• Increase the separation between the
chemical known to the State of
equipment and receiver.
California to cause birth defects or
• Connect the equipment into an
other reproductive harm. Wash hands
outlet on a circuit different from that
after handling.
to which the receiver is connected.
• Consult the dealer or an experienced Nikon Inc., 1300 Walt Whitman Road,
radio/television technician for help. Melville, New York 11747-3064, U.S.A.
Tel.: 631-547-4200

xviii

Notice Concerning Prohibition of Copying or Reproduction
Note that simply being in possession of material that has been digitally
copied or reproduced by means of a scanner, digital camera, or other device
may be punishable by law.
• Items prohibited by law from being copied • Cautions on certain copies and
reproductions
or reproduced
The government has issued cautions
Do not copy or reproduce paper
on copies or reproductions of
money, coins, securities,
government bonds, or local
securities issued by private
companies (shares, bills, checks, gift
government bonds, even if such
certificates, etc.), commuter passes,
copies or reproductions are
or coupon tickets, except when a
stamped “Sample.”
minimum of necessary copies are to
The copying or reproduction of
be provided for business use by a
paper money, coins, or securities
company. Also, do not copy or
which are circulated in a foreign
reproduce passports issued by the
country is prohibited.
government, licenses issued by
Unless the prior permission of the
public agencies and private groups,
government has been obtained, the ID cards, and tickets, such as passes
copying or reproduction of unused
and meal coupons.
postage stamps or post cards issued
• Comply with copyright notices
by the government is prohibited.
Under copyright law, photographs
The copying or reproduction of
or recordings of copyrighted works
stamps issued by the government
made with the camera can not be
and of certified documents
used without the permission of the
stipulated by law is prohibited.
copyright holder. Exceptions apply
to personal use, but note that even
personal use may be restricted in
the case of photographs or
recordings of exhibits or live
performances.

xix

Disposing of Data Storage Devices
Please note that deleting images or formatting memory cards or other data
storage devices does not completely erase the original image data. Deleted
files can sometimes be recovered from discarded storage devices using
commercially available software, potentially resulting in the malicious use of
personal image data. Ensuring the privacy of such data is the user’s
responsibility.
Before discarding a data storage device or transferring ownership to another
person, erase all data using commercial deletion software, or format the
device and then completely refill it with images containing no private
information (for example, pictures of empty sky). Be sure to also replace any
pictures selected for preset manual (0 149). Before discarding the camera or
transferring ownership to another person, you should also use the Wi-Fi >
Reset connection settings (0 272) option in the camera setup menu to
delete any personal network information. Care should be taken to avoid
injury when physically destroying data storage devices.

AVC Patent Portfolio License
THIS PRODUCT IS LICENSED UNDER THE AVC PATENT PORTFOLIO LICENSE FOR THE PERSONAL
AND NON-COMMERCIAL USE OF A CONSUMER TO (i) ENCODE VIDEO IN COMPLIANCE WITH
THE AVC STANDARD (“AVC VIDEO”) AND/OR (ii) DECODE AVC VIDEO THAT WAS ENCODED
BY A CONSUMER ENGAGED IN A PERSONAL AND NON-COMMERCIAL ACTIVITY AND/OR WAS
OBTAINED FROM A VIDEO PROVIDER LICENSED TO PROVIDE AVC VIDEO. NO LICENSE IS
GRANTED OR SHALL BE IMPLIED FOR ANY OTHER USE. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION MAY BE
OBTAINED FROM MPEG LA, L.L.C. SEE http://www.mpegla.com

Use Only Nikon Brand Electronic Accessories
Nikon cameras are designed to the highest standards and include complex
electronic circuitry. Only Nikon brand electronic accessories (including
chargers, batteries, AC adapters, and flash accessories) certified by Nikon
specifically for use with this Nikon digital camera are engineered and proven
to operate within the operational and safety requirements of this electronic
circuitry.
The use of non-Nikon electronic accessories could damage
the camera and may void your Nikon warranty. The use of
third-party rechargeable Li-ion batteries not bearing the
Nikon holographic seal shown at right could interfere with
normal operation of the camera or result in the batteries overheating,
igniting, rupturing, or leaking.
For more information about Nikon brand accessories, contact a local
authorized Nikon dealer.

xx

D Use Only Nikon Brand Accessories
Only Nikon brand accessories certified by Nikon specifically for use with
your Nikon digital camera are engineered and proven to operate within its
operational and safety requirements. THE USE OF NON-NIKON ACCESSORIES
COULD DAMAGE YOUR CAMERA AND MAY VOID YOUR NIKON WARRANTY.

A Before Taking Important Pictures
Before taking pictures on important occasions (such as at weddings or
before taking the camera on a trip), take a test shot to ensure that the
camera is functioning normally. Nikon will not be held liable for damages
or lost profits that may result from product malfunction.

A Life-Long Learning
As part of Nikon’s “Life-Long Learning” commitment to ongoing product
support and education, continually-updated information is available online at the following sites:
• For users in the U.S.A.: http://www.nikonusa.com/
• For users in Europe and Africa: http://www.europe-nikon.com/support/
• For users in Asia, Oceania, and the Middle East: http://www.nikon-asia.com/
Visit these sites to keep up-to-date with the latest product information, tips,
answers to frequently-asked questions (FAQs), and general advice on digital
imaging and photography. Additional information may be available from
the Nikon representative in your area. See the following URL for contact
information: http://imaging.nikon.com/

xxi

Bluetooth and Wi-Fi (Wireless LAN)
This product is controlled by the United States Export Administration
Regulations (EAR). The permission of the United States government is not
required for export to countries other than the following, which as of this
writing are subject to embargo or special controls: Cuba, Iran, North Korea,
Sudan, and Syria (list subject to change).
The use of wireless devices may be prohibited in some countries or regions.
Contact a Nikon-authorized service representative before using the wireless
features of this product outside the country of purchase.

Notice for Customers in the U.S.A. and Canada
This device complies with Part 15 of FCC Rules and Industry Canada licenceexempt RSS standard(s). Operation is subject to the following two conditions:
(1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any
interference, including interference that may cause undesired operation of
the device.
FCC WARNING
The FCC requires the user to be notified that any changes or modifications
made to this device that are not expressly approved by Nikon Corporation
may void the user’s authority to operate the equipment.
FCC Radio Frequency Interference Statement
Note: This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for
a Class B digital device, pursuant to part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are
designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a
residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio
frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the
instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications.
However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular
installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or
television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off
and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or
more of the following measures:
• Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
• Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
• Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to
which the receiver is connected.
• Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.
Co-location
This transmitter must not be co-located or operated in conjunction with any
other antenna or transmitter.
Nikon Inc., 1300 Walt Whitman Road, Melville, New York 11747-3064, U.S.A.
Tel.: 631-547-4200

xxii

FCC/IC RF Exposure Statement
The available scientific evidence does not show that any health problems are
associated with using low power wireless devices. There is no proof, however,
that these low power wireless devices are absolutely safe. Low power
wireless devices emit low levels of radio frequency energy (RF) in the
microwave range while being used. Whereas high levels of RF can produce
health effects (by heating tissue), exposure of low-level RF that does not
produce heating effects causes no known adverse health effects. Many
studies of low-level RF exposures have not found any biological effects. Some
studies have suggested that some biological effects might occur, but such
findings have not been confirmed by additional research. The D5600, which
is equipped with a LBEE5UW1FS (FCC ID:VPYLB1FS / IC ID:772C-LB1FS)
Wireless LAN Module, has been tested and found to comply with FCC/IC
radiation exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment and
meets the FCC radio frequency (RF) Exposure Guidelines in Supplement C to
OET65 and RSS-102 of the IC radio frequency (RF) Exposure rules. Please refer
to the SAR test report that was uploaded to FCC website.

Notices for Customers in Europe
Hereby, Nikon Corporation, declares that the D5600 is in
compliance with the essential requirements and other relevant
provisions of Directive 1999/5/EC. The declaration of conformity
may be consulted at http://imaging.nikon.com/support/pdf/DoC_D5600.pdf

Notice for Customers in Singapore
Trade Name:
Model: D5600
This device complies with radio-frequency regulations. The content of
certification labels not affixed to the device is given below.
Complies with
IDA Standards
DA103423

xxiii

Security
Although one of the benefits of this product is that it allows others to freely
connect for the wireless exchange of data anywhere within its range, the
following may occur if security is not enabled:
• Data theft: Malicious third-parties may intercept wireless transmissions to
steal user IDs, passwords, and other personal information.
• Unauthorized access: Unauthorized users may gain access to the network
and alter data or perform other malicious actions. Note that due to the
design of wireless networks, specialized attacks may allow unauthorized
access even when security is enabled.
• Unsecured networks: Connecting to open networks may result in
unauthorized access. Use secure networks only.

xxiv

Introduction
Getting to Know the Camera
Take a few moments to familiarize yourself with camera controls
and displays. You may find it helpful to bookmark this section
and refer to it as you read through the rest of the manual.

The Camera Body

18

5
4
3
2
1

6 7

8
9
10

17

16

1 AF-assist illuminator ........... 85, 237
Self-timer lamp.............................. 80
Red-eye reduction lamp ..102, 104
2 Power switch............................33, 39
3 Shutter-release button................. 52
4 E/N button...............124, 132, 134
5 Movie-record button .................165
6 Live view switch ................... 47, 164
7 Mode dial...........................................4
8 Built-in flash .................................101
9 M/ Y button.............101, 103, 134

10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18

15

11
12
13
14

Eyelets for camera strap.............. 26
Fn button ...................................... 252
Mounting mark ............................. 30
Lens release button...................... 31
I/E button.............. 75, 76, 78, 79
Mirror............................................. 330
Lens mount ..............................30, 96
CPU contacts
Body cap ................................ 30, 323

Introduction

1

19 20 21
22 23 24
28
27
31
26
30

25

29
19 Stereo microphone .................... 169
20 Accessory shoe
(for optional flash units) .......... 315
21 Eye sensor.................................8, 265
22 R (information) button.......6, 9, 115
23 Command dial
24 A/L button .....94, 130, 200, 254
25 Connector cover

G button ..................42, 115, 220
Speaker
Focal plane mark (E)...................96
USB connector ................... 211, 214
Connector for external
microphone ...............................170
31 Accessory terminal..................... 324
26
27
28
29
30

D Close the Connector Cover
Close the connector cover when the connectors are not in use. Foreign
matter in the connectors can interfere with data transfer.

D The Speaker
Do not place the speaker in close proximity to magnetic devices.
Failure to observe this precaution could affect the data recorded on
the magnetic devices.

2

Introduction

47

32

33 34

36

35

37
38
39
40
46

48
49
50

45

44 43

Viewfinder eyepiece.......... 5, 41, 80
Diopter adjustment control ....... 41
K button............................... 56, 184
P button........................ 12, 166, 187
Multi selector ....................33, 39, 43
J (OK) button..................33, 39, 43
N-Mark (NFC antenna)................. 34
O button ................................ 57, 205
Memory card access lamp .......... 51
Battery-chamber cover
latch .................................27, 28, 325
42 Battery-chamber cover
..........................................27, 28, 325
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41

42 41
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51

51

W/Q button.................43, 185, 196
X button.............................. 185, 196
Tripod socket
Vari-angle monitor
....................13, 15, 47, 56, 184, 255
Rubber eyecup .............................. 80
HDMI connector cover .............. 218
Memory card slot cover ........27, 28
Power connector cover for
optional power connector ...... 325
Battery latch....................27, 28, 325

Introduction

3

The Mode Dial
The camera offers a choice of the
following shooting modes.

P, S, A, and M Modes:
• P—Programmed auto (0 119)
• S —Shutter-priority auto (0 121)
• A—Aperture-priority auto (0 122)
• M—Manual (0 123)

Special Effects Modes (0 65)

Auto Modes:
• i Auto (0 47)
• j Auto (flash off) (0 47)

Scene Modes (0 58)

4

Introduction

The Viewfinder
Note: Display shown with all indicators lit
for illustrative purposes.

1

3

2

78

4
5
6
1 Framing grid (displayed when On
is selected for Custom Setting d3,
Viewfinder grid display) ...243
2 Focus points ....................50, 90, 236
3 AF area brackets......................41, 49
4 Low battery warning ................... 46
5 Monochrome indicator (displayed
in % mode or when the
Monochrome Picture Control or
a Picture Control based on
Monochrome is
selected) ............................... 65, 155
6 “No memory card” indicator...... 27
7 Focus indicator ........................50, 96
8 Autoexposure (AE) lock
indicator.......................................130
9 Shutter speed ..............................118
10 Aperture (f-number) ..................118
11 Special effects mode
indicator......................................... 65
12 Bracketing indicator...................151

16

9 10

11 12 1314 15
17 18 20
19

21

13 Number of exposures
remaining...................................... 46
Number of shots remaining before
memory buffer fills ..................... 77
White balance recording
indicator ...................................... 146
Exposure compensation
value ............................................. 132
Flash compensation value........ 134
ISO sensitivity ..................... 107, 239
Capture mode indicator
14 “k” (appears when memory
remains for over 1000
exposures)..................................... 46
15 Flash-ready indicator................... 54
16 Flexible program indicator....... 120
17 Exposure indicator ..................... 124
Exposure compensation
display.......................................... 132
Electronic rangefinder............... 237
18 Flash compensation indicator... 134
19 Exposure compensation
indicator ...................................... 132
20 Auto ISO sensitivity indicator .. 228
21 Warning indicator....................... 349

Introduction

5

The R (Info) Button
Press the R button to view the information display or cycle
through display options.

❚❚ Viewfinder Photography
To view shutter speed, aperture, the
number of exposures remaining, AF-area
mode, and other shooting information in
the monitor, press the R button.
R button

1
2

6
7

3
4
5
1 Shooting mode
i auto/
j auto (flash off).....................47
Scene modes ............................58
Special effects mode ..............65
P, S, A, and M modes............. 118
2 Shutter speed .............................. 118
Shutter-speed display ...... 121, 124
3 Autoexposure (AE) lock
indicator ...................................... 130

6

Introduction

8
4 Release mode.................................75
5 Help icon ...................................... 349
6 Aperture (f-number).................. 118
Aperture display ................ 122, 124
7 ISO sensitivity.............................. 107
ISO sensitivity display....... 107, 229
Auto ISO sensitivity
indicator ...................................... 229
8 z icon..............................................22

9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18

19
20

22
23
24

21

9 Satellite signal indicator............269
10 Wi-Fi connection indicator .......272
Eye-Fi connection indicator .....274
11 Bluetooth connection indicator
.......................................................273
Airplane mode.............................271
12 Touch Fn assignment.................255
13 Vignette control indicator ........231
14 Exposure delay mode ................241
15 Date stamp indicator .................243
16 Vibration reduction indicator
................................................ 32, 232
17 Flash control indicator...............246
Flash compensation indicator for
optional flash units ...................318
18 Battery indicator ........................... 46
19 Bracketing indicator...................151

20 AF-area mode indicator .............. 87
Focus point............................ 90, 236
21 Exposure indicator ..................... 124
Exposure compensation
indicator ...................................... 132
Bracketing progress
indicator ...................................... 154
22 ADL bracketing amount............ 152
23 Number of exposures
remaining...................................... 46
White balance recording
indicator ...................................... 146
Capture mode indicator
24 “k” (appears when memory
remains for over 1000
exposures)..................................... 46

Note: Display shown with all indicators lit for illustrative purposes.

Introduction

7

A Turning the Monitor Off
To clear shooting information from the monitor, press the R button or
press the shutter-release button halfway. The monitor will turn off
automatically if no operations are performed for about 8 seconds (for
information on choosing how long the monitor stays on, see Auto off
timers on page 240). The monitor will also turn off if you cover the eye
sensor or look through the viewfinder.

A Info Display Auto Off
The eye sensor will automatically turn the information display off if you
put your eye to the viewfinder while the standby timer is active. The
display will turn on again when you remove your eye from the
viewfinder. If desired, you can prevent the information display turning
off using the Info display auto off option (0 265) in the setup menu.
Note, however, that regardless of the option selected the information
display will turn off when the standby timer expires.

8

Introduction

❚❚ Live View and Movie Mode
To start live view, rotate the live view
switch during viewfinder photography
(0 47). You can then press the R button
to cycle through display options as
shown below.
R button

Show detailed photo
indicators

Show movie indicators
(0 164) *

Show basic photo indicators *

Hide indicators*

Framing grid*
* A crop showing the area recorded is displayed during movie recording;
circled areas indicate the edges of the movie frame crop (the area
outside the movie frame crop is grayed out when movie indicators are
displayed).

Introduction

9

The Live View Display

q
w
e
r
t
y

Item

u

Description
The mode currently selected with
q Shooting mode
the mode dial.
Displayed when On is selected for
Manual movie settings
Manual movie settings in mode
w indicator
M.
The amount of time remaining
before live view ends
e Time remaining
automatically. Displayed if
shooting will end in 30 s or less.
Displayed when On is selected for
r Wind noise reduction Movie settings > Wind noise
reduction in the shooting menu.
Microphone sensitivity for movie
t Microphone sensitivity recording.
Sound level for audio recording.
Displayed in red if level is too high;
y Sound level
adjust microphone sensitivity
accordingly.
The current focus point. The
display varies with the option
u Focus point
selected for AF-area mode (0 89).

10 Introduction

0
47, 58,
65, 118
169

11

169
169

169

49

i

o !0
!1
!2

!3
Item

Description
The frame size of movies recorded
in movie mode.
Focus mode
The current focus mode.
AF-area mode
The current AF-area mode.
Indicates that movies can not be
“No movie” icon
recorded.
Time remaining (movie The recording time remaining in
mode)
movie mode.
Indicates whether the photograph
Exposure indicator
would be under- or over-exposed
at current settings (mode M only).

0

i Movie frame size

168

o
!0

83
89

!1
!2
!3

—
165
124

D The Count Down Display
A count down will be displayed 30 s before live view ends
automatically (0 10); the timer turns red 5 s before the auto off timer
expires (0 240) or if live view is about to end to protect the internal
circuits. Depending on shooting conditions, the timer may appear
immediately when live view is selected. Movie recording will end
automatically when the timer expires, regardless of the amount of
recording time available.

Introduction 11

The P Button
To change the settings at the bottom of
the information display, press the P
button, then highlight items using the
multi selector and press J to view
options for the highlighted item. You can
also change settings by pressing the P
P button
button during live view.
• Image quality (0 98)
• Image size (0 100)
• Auto bracketing (0 151)
• HDR (high dynamic range) (0 138)
• Active D-Lighting (0 136)
Viewfinder photography
• White balance (0 140)
• ISO sensitivity (0 107)
• Picture Control (0 155)
• Focus mode (0 82)
• AF-area mode (0 87)
• Metering (0 128)
Live view
• Flash mode (0 102, 104)
• Flash compensation (0 134)
• Exposure compensation (0 132)

12 Introduction

The Monitor
The monitor can be angled and rotated as shown below.

180°

90°

180°

Normal use: Fold the monitor
against the camera face out. The
monitor is normally used in this
position.
Low-angle shots: Tilt the monitor
up to take shots in live view with
the camera held low.

High-angle shots: Tilt the monitor
down to take shots in live view
with the camera held high.

Self-portraits: Use for self-portraits
in live view. The monitor shows
a mirror image of what will
appear in the final picture.

Introduction 13

D Using the Monitor
Rotate the monitor gently within the limits shown. Do not use force.
Failure to observe these precautions could damage the camera or
monitor. To protect the monitor when the camera is not in use, fold it
back face down against the camera body.
Do not lift or carry the camera by the monitor. Failure to observe this
precaution could damage the camera.

14 Introduction

Using the Touch Screen
The touch-sensitive monitor supports the following operations:
Flick
Flick a finger a short distance left or right
across the monitor.

Slide
Slide a finger over the monitor.

Stretch/Pinch
Place two fingers on the monitor and
move them apart or pinch them together.

Introduction 15

D The Touch Screen
The touch screen responds to static electricity and may not respond
when covered with third-party protective films or when touched with
fingernails or gloved hands. Do not use excessive force or touch the
screen with sharp objects.

D Using the Touch Screen
The touch screen may not respond as expected if you attempt to
operate it while leaving your palm or another finger resting on it in
second location. It may not recognize other gestures if your touch is
too soft, your fingers are moved too quickly or too short a distance or
do not remain in contact with the screen, or if the movement of the
two fingers in a pinch or stretch is not correctly coordinated.

A Enabling or Disabling Touch Controls
Touch controls can be enabled or disabled using the Touch controls
option in the setup menu (0 263). Select Enable to enable touch
controls for shooting, playback, and menu navigation or Playback
only to enable touch controls for playback only.

16 Introduction

Touch-Screen Photography
Tap icons in the shooting display to adjust camera settings (note
that not all icons will respond to touch-screen operations).
During live view, you can also take photographs by tapping the
monitor.

❚❚ Viewfinder Photography
Use the touch screen to adjust settings in the information
display (0 6).
Scene/Effect Selection
In scene and special effects modes (0 58, 65), you can tap the
shooting mode icon to choose a scene or effect. Tap x or y to
view the different options and tap an icon to select and return to
the previous display.

Shutter Speed and Aperture
In modes S, A, and M, you can tap the w icon next to the shutter
speed or aperture displays to view x and y controls, which you
can tap to choose a new value. Tap 1 to exit when the operation
is complete.

Introduction 17

Shooting Options
To change camera settings (0 12), tap the z icon at the bottom
right corner of the display and then tap icons to display options
for the corresponding setting. Tap the desired option to select it
and return to the previous display.

If prompted to choose a value as shown
at right, edit the value by tapping u or v
and then tap the number or tap 0 to
select it and return to the previous
display.
To exit without changing settings, tap
2.

18 Introduction

❚❚ Live View Photography
Use the touch screen to take photographs and adjust settings.
Taking Photographs (Touch Shutter)
Touch your subject in the monitor to
focus. Focus locks until you lift your
finger from the monitor to take the
photograph (note that the touch shutter
can not be used to focus when MF—
manual focus—is selected for focus mode). For more
information on touch focus, see page 83.
To disable the touch shutter, tap the
icon at right. The icon will change to
7, indicating that the shutter will no
longer be released when you lift your
finger from the monitor.
The touch shutter remains off (7) during movie recording, but
you can refocus at any time by touching your subject in the
monitor.

Introduction 19

D Taking Pictures Using Touch Shooting Options
The shutter-release button can be used to focus and take pictures even
when the 3 icon is displayed to show that touch shooting options are
active. Use the shutter-release button to take photographs in
continuous shooting mode (0 76) and during movie recording. Touch
shooting options can be used only to take pictures one at a time in
continuous shooting mode and can not be used to take photographs
during movie recording.
In self-timer mode (0 79), focus locks on the selected subject when
you touch the monitor and the timer starts when you lift your finger
from the screen. At default settings, the shutter is released about 10 s
after the timer starts; the delay and number of shots can be changed
using Custom Setting c3 (Self-timer, 0 241). If the option selected for
Number of shots is greater than 1, the camera will automatically take
pictures one after the other until the selected number of shots is
recorded.

20 Introduction

Scene/Effect Selection
In scene and special effects modes (0 58, 65), you can tap the
shooting mode icon to choose a scene or effect. Tap x or y to
view the different options and tap an icon to select and return to
the previous display.

Shutter Speed and Aperture
In modes S, A, and M, tapping the shutter speed or aperture
displays x and y controls, which you can tap to choose a new
value. Tap 1 to exit when the operation is complete.

Introduction 21

Shooting Options
In live view, pressing the P button or tapping the z icon in the
monitor activates the information display (0 12, 166). Tap a
setting to view options and then tap the desired option to select
it and return to live view.

If prompted to choose a value as shown
at right, edit the value by tapping u or v
and then tap the number or tap 0 to
select it and return to the previous
display.
To exit without changing settings, tap
2.

22 Introduction

Viewing Pictures
The touch screen can be used for the following playback
operations (0 56, 184).

View other
images

Flick left or right to view other
images.

Scroll
rapidly to
other
images

In full frame view, you can touch
the bottom of the display to
display a frame advance bar,
then slide your finger left or right
to scroll rapidly to other images.

Frame advance bar
Zoom in
(photos
only)

Use stretch and pinch gestures to
zoom in and out and slide to
scroll (0 196).

Introduction 23

View
thumbnails

To “zoom out” to a thumbnail
view (0 185), use a pinch
gesture in full-frame playback.
Use pinch and stretch to choose
the number of images displayed
from 4, 12, or 80 frames.

View movies

Tap the on-screen guide to start
movie playback (movies are
indicated by a 1 icon). Tap the
display to pause or resume, or
tap 1 to exit to full-frame
playback (note that some of the
icons in the movie playback
display do not respond to touchscreen operations).

24 Introduction

Guide

Using the Menus
The touch screen can be used for the following menu
operations.

Scroll

Slide up or down to scroll.

Choose a
menu

Tap a menu icon to choose a
menu.

Select
options/
adjust
settings

Tap menu items to display
options and tap icons or sliders
to change. To exit without
changing settings, tap 1.

Introduction 25

First Steps
Attach the Camera Strap
Attach the strap securely to the two camera eyelets.

Charge the Battery
If a plug adapter is supplied, raise the wall plug and connect the
plug adapter as shown below at left, making sure the plug is fully
inserted. Insert the battery and plug the charger in. An
exhausted battery will fully charge in about an hour and
50 minutes.

Battery charging
Charging complete

D The Battery and Charger
Read and follow the warnings and cautions on pages xiii–xvi and 333–337
of this manual.

26 First Steps

Insert the Battery and a Memory Card
Before inserting or removing the battery or memory cards,
confirm that power switch is in the OFF position. Insert the
battery as shown, using the battery to keep the orange battery
latch pressed to one side. The latch locks the battery in place
when the battery is fully inserted.

Battery latch

Holding the memory card in the orientation shown, slide it in
until it clicks into place.

A The Clock Battery
The camera clock is powered by an independent, rechargeable power
source, which is charged as necessary when the main battery is
installed. Three days of charging will power the clock for about a
month. If a message warning that the clock is not set is displayed
when the camera is turned on, the clock battery is exhausted and the
clock has been reset. Set the clock to the correct time and date.

First Steps 27

❚❚ Removing the Battery and Memory Cards

Removing Memory Cards
After confirming that the memory card
access lamp is off, turn the camera off,
open the memory card slot cover, and
press the card in to eject it (q). The card
can then be removed by hand (w).

16GB

Removing the Battery
To remove the battery, turn the camera
off and open the battery-chamber cover.
Press the battery latch in the direction
shown by the arrow to release the
battery and then remove the battery by
hand.

D Memory Cards
• Memory cards may be hot after use. Observe due caution when
removing memory cards from the camera.
• Do not remove memory cards from the camera, turn the camera off,
or remove or disconnect the power source during formatting or while
data are being recorded, deleted, or copied to a computer. Failure to
observe these precautions could result in loss of data or in damage to
the camera or card.
• Do not touch the card terminals with your fingers or metal objects.
• Do not bend, drop, or subject to strong physical shocks.
• Do not apply force to the card casing. Failure to observe this
precaution could damage the card.
• Do not expose to water, heat, high levels of humidity, or direct
sunlight.
• Do not format memory cards in a computer.

28 First Steps

Open the Monitor
Open the monitor as shown. Do not use force.

First Steps 29

Attach a Lens
Be careful to prevent dust from entering the camera when the
lens or body cap is removed. The lens generally used in this
manual for illustrative purposes is an AF-P DX NIKKOR 18–55mm
f/3.5–5.6G VR.
Remove the camera
body cap

Remove the rear
lens cap
Mounting mark (camera)

Align the mounting
marks

Mounting mark (lens)

Rotate the lens as shown until it clicks into place.

Be sure to remove the lens cap before taking pictures.

30 First Steps

A Lenses with Retractable Lens Barrel Buttons
Before using the camera, unlock and extend the lens. Keeping the
retractable lens barrel button pressed (q), rotate the zoom ring as
shown (w).

Retractable lens barrel button
Pictures can not be taken when the lens is
retracted; if an error message is displayed as
a result of the camera having been turned
on with the lens retracted, rotate the zoom
ring until the message is no longer
displayed.

A Detaching the Lens
Be sure the camera is off when removing or
exchanging lenses. To remove the lens,
press and hold the lens release button (q)
while turning the lens clockwise (w). After
removing the lens, replace the lens caps and
camera body cap.

A A-M, M/A-M, and A/M-M Switches
When using autofocus with a lens equipped
with an A-M mode switch, slide the switch to
A (if the lens has an M/A-M or A/M-M switch,
select M/A or A/M). For information on other
lenses that can be used with this camera, see
page 305.

First Steps 31

A Vibration Reduction (VR)
Vibration reduction can be enabled by
selecting On for Optical VR in the shooting
menu (0 232), if the lens supports this
option, or by sliding the lens vibration
reduction switch to ON, if the lens is
equipped with a vibration reduction switch.
A vibration reduction indicator appears in
the information display when vibration
reduction is on.

A Retracting Lenses with Retractable Lens Barrel Buttons
To retract the lens when the camera is not in
use, press and hold the retractable lens
barrel button (q) and rotate the zoom ring
to the “L” (lock) position as shown (w).
Retract the lens before removing it from the
camera, and be careful not to press the
retractable lens barrel button when
attaching or removing the lens.

32 First Steps

Camera Setup
❚❚ Setup from a Smartphone or Tablet
Before proceeding, install the SnapBridge app as
described inside the front cover and enable
Bluetooth and Wi-Fi on your smartphone or tablet
(below, “smart device”). Note that the actual camera
and smart device displays may differ from those shown below.

1 Turn the camera on.
A language-selection dialog will be
displayed.

Use the multi selector and J button to navigate the menus.

Power switch
1 Up
J button (select)
4 Left

2 Right
3 Down
Multi selector

Press 1 and 3 to highlight a language and press J to select.
The language can be changed at any time using the
Language option in the setup menu.

First Steps 33

2 Press J when the dialog at right is
displayed.
If you do not wish to use a smart
device to configure the camera, press
G (0 40).

3 Pair the camera and the smart
device.

• Android devices with NFC support: After
checking that NFC is enabled on the
smart device, touch the camera
H (N-Mark) to the NFC antenna on
the smart device to launch the
SnapBridge app. If the SnapBridge
download site is displayed,
download and install the app before repeating the above
steps.
• iOS devices and Android devices without
NFC support: Press the camera J
button. The camera will wait for a
connection; launch the SnapBridge
app on the smart device and follow
the on-screen instructions to tap the
name of the camera you want to pair
with.
Connect to Camera

Camera name
D5600

34 First Steps

4 Check the authentication code.
After confirming that the camera and
smart device display the same sixdigit authentication code, follow the
steps below to complete pairing (note
that the code may not be displayed in
Camera
some versions of iOS, but you should
follow the steps below even if the code is not displayed).
• On the camera, press J.
• On the smart device, tap PAIR (the name of the button varies
with the smart device).

5 Press J when the dialog at right is
displayed.
You have now established a constant
connection between the camera and
smart device. If the camera displays
Unable to connect., the display will
change after a short pause. Return to Step 3.

First Steps 35

6 Follow the on-screen instructions to complete the setup
process.
To record location data with photographs, select Yes when
prompted and enable the location data features both in the
SnapBridge app and on the smart device itself (for more
information, see the documentation provided with the smart
device). You can also synchronize the camera clock to the
time reported by the smart device by selecting Yes when
prompted and enabling synchronization in the SnapBridge
app. If you select No, set the camera clock from the menus as
described in Step 3 on page 40.
Setup is complete when the camera returns to the shooting
display. See page 37 for more information on using
SnapBridge.

36 First Steps

A What SnapBridge Can Do for You
The SnapBridge app can be used for a variety of tasks once the camera
has been paired with your smart device. For more information on the
features below, see SnapBridge online help.
Auto Upload
At default settings, JPEG photographs will automatically be uploaded
to the smart device as they are taken (auto upload is not available with
movies or with NEF/RAW images, and is automatically suspended
when the battery level drops to H). Before uploading pictures, place
the smart device close to the camera and launch the SnapBridge app.
Here are some tips for uploading pictures:
• Disabling auto upload: To disable auto upload, select Off for Send to
smart device (auto) in the camera setup menu (0 272).
• Uploading selected pictures: To upload pictures not previously sent using
auto upload, press the camera P button during playback and select
pictures using Select to send to smart device/deselect (0 203), or
select pictures using the Select to send to smart device option in
the camera playback menu (0 204). Note that as long as a constant
connection is in effect between the camera and smart device,
pictures will be uploaded automatically even when the camera is off.
Upload is however automatically suspended when the battery level
drops to H.
• Resizing pictures for upload: Choose an upload size in the SnapBridge
app. The default is 2 megapixels.
• Embedding photo info: Use the SnapBridge app to choose the
information you want imprinted on photographs copied to the smart
device. Comments and copyright information can be entered in
advance from the camera setup menu. You can also imprint text
entered in the SnapBridge app.

First Steps 37

Tips for Wireless Networks
• Pairing: To pair the camera with a smart device (for example, with a
new device or if you did not opt to pair with a smart device during
setup), select Set for Connect to smart device in the camera setup
menu and follow the instructions on page 34, starting with Step 3.
The camera can be paired with up to five smart devices, but can
connect to only one at a time.
• Uploading pictures via Wi-Fi: A Wi-Fi connection is recommended for
movies and other large-volume uploads. Follow the on-screen
instructions in the SnapBridge app to switch to a Wi-Fi connection.
The Wi-Fi > Network settings item in the camera setup menu
contains Authentication/encryption and Password options. The
default option for Authentication/encryption is WPA2-PSK-AES.
Other Features of the SnapBridge App
• Remote photography: The camera shutter can be released remotely from
the smart device using the SnapBridge app. Be sure the camera is on
before attempting to take pictures.
• Viewing pictures from the smart device: Use the smart device to view and
download the pictures on the camera. This option is available even
when the camera is off.

A Where the Use of Wireless Devices Is Prohibited
Where the use of wireless devices is prohibited, disable wireless
features in the camera setup menu by selecting Enable for Airplane
mode. This will temporarily interrupt the constant connection with
the smart device, but the connection is automatically re-established
when airplane mode is disabled.

38 First Steps

❚❚ Setup from the Camera Menus
The camera clock can be set manually.

1 Turn the camera on.
A language-selection dialog will be
displayed.

Use the multi selector and J button to navigate the menus.

Power switch
1 Up
J button (select)
4 Left

2 Right
3 Down
Multi selector

Press 1 and 3 to highlight a language and press J to select.
The language can be changed at any time using the
Language option in the setup menu.

First Steps 39

2 Press G when the dialog at right is
displayed.

G button

3 Set the camera clock.
Use the multi selector and J button to set the camera clock.
q

w

Select time zone
e

Select date format
r

Select daylight saving time
option

Set time and date (note that the
camera uses a 24-hour clock)

The clock can be adjusted at any time using the Time zone
and date > Date and time option in the setup menu.

40 First Steps

Focus the Viewfinder
After removing the lens cap,
rotate the diopter adjustment
control until the AF area
brackets are in sharp focus.
When operating the control
with your eye to the
viewfinder, be careful not to
put your fingers or fingernails in your eye.

AF area
brackets

Viewfinder not in focus

Viewfinder in focus

The camera is now ready for use. Proceed to page 47 for
information on taking photographs.

First Steps 41

Tutorial
Camera Menus: An Overview
Most shooting, playback, and setup
options can be accessed from the camera
menus. To view the menus, press the
G button.

G button
Tabs
Choose from the following menus:
• D: Playback (0 220)
• C: Shooting (0 223)
• A: Custom Settings (0 233)
• B: Setup (0 257)

• N: Retouch (0 277)
• m/O: Recent settings or My Menu
(defaults to Recent settings;
0 300)
Slider shows position in
current menu.

Current settings are shown by
icons.

Menu options
Options in current menu.
Help icon (0 43)

42 Tutorial

Using Camera Menus
❚❚ Menu Controls
The multi selector and J button are used to navigate the
camera menus.
1: Move cursor up
J button: select
highlighted item
4: Cancel and return to
previous menu

2: Select highlighted item
or display sub-menu

3: Move cursor down

A The d (Help) Icon
If a d icon is displayed at the bottom left corner of the monitor, a
description of the currently selected option or menu can be displayed
by pressing the W (Q) button. Press 1 or 3 to scroll through the
display. Press W (Q) again to return to the menus.

W (Q) button

Tutorial 43

❚❚ Navigating the Menus
Follow the steps below to navigate the menus.

1 Display the menus.
Press the G button to
display the menus.

G button

2 Highlight the icon for the
current menu.
Press 4 to highlight the
icon for the current menu.

3 Select a menu.
Press 1 or 3 to select the desired menu.

4 Position the cursor in the
selected menu.
Press 2 to position the
cursor in the selected
menu.

44 Tutorial

5 Highlight a menu item.
Press 1 or 3 to highlight a
menu item.

6 Display options.
Press 2 to display options
for the selected menu item.

7 Highlight an option.
Press 1 or 3 to highlight
an option.

8 Select the highlighted item.
Press J to select the highlighted item. To exit
without making a selection, press the G button.
Note the following:
• Menu items that are displayed in gray are not currently
available.
• While pressing 2 generally has the same effect as pressing J,
there are some cases in which selection can only be made by
pressing J.
• To exit the menus and return to shooting mode, press the
shutter-release button halfway (0 52).

Tutorial 45

The Battery Level and Number of
Exposures Remaining
Press the R button and check the battery level and number of
exposures remaining in the information display.
Battery level

R button

Number of exposures
remaining

Battery Level
If the battery is low, a warning will also be displayed in the
viewfinder. If the information display does not appear when the
R button is pressed, the battery is exhausted and needs to be
recharged.
Information
display
L
K

Viewfinder

Description

—
—

Battery fully charged.
Battery partially discharged.
Low battery. Ready fully-charged spare
battery or prepare to charge battery.

H

d

H
(flashes)

d
(flashes)

Battery exhausted. Charge battery.

Number of Exposures Remaining
Values over 1000 are shown in thousands, indicated by the letter
“k”.

46 Tutorial

Basic Photography and Playback
“Point-and-Shoot” Modes (i and j)
This section describes how to take
photographs in i and j modes. i and j are
automatic “point-and-shoot” modes in which
the majority of settings are controlled by the
camera in response to shooting conditions; the
only difference between the two is that the
flash will not fire in j mode.

1 Rotate the mode dial to i

Mode dial

or j.

Photographs can be framed in the
viewfinder or in the monitor (live
view). To start live view, rotate the live
view switch.

Live view switch

Framing pictures in the
viewfinder

Framing pictures in the
monitor (live view)

Basic Photography and Playback 47

2 Ready the camera.
Viewfinder photography: When framing photographs in the
viewfinder, hold the handgrip in your right hand and cradle
the camera body or lens with your left. Bring your elbows in
against the sides of your chest.

Live view: When framing photographs in the monitor, hold the
handgrip in your right hand and cradle the lens with your left.

A Framing Photographs in Portrait (Tall) Orientation
When framing photographs in portrait (tall) orientation, hold the
camera as shown below.

Framing photographs in the
viewfinder

48 Basic Photography and Playback

Framing photographs in the
monitor

3 Frame the photograph.
Viewfinder photography: Frame a
photograph in the viewfinder with the
main subject in the AF area brackets.

AF area brackets

Live view: At default settings, the
camera automatically detects faces
and selects the focus point. If no face
is detected, the camera will focus on
subjects near the center of the frame.
Focus point

A Using a Zoom Lens
Before focusing, rotate the zoom ring to
Zoom in
adjust the focal length and frame the
photograph. Use the zoom ring to zoom in
on the subject so that it fills a larger area of
the frame, or zoom out to increase the area
visible in the final photograph (select longer
focal lengths on the lens focal length scale to
zoom in, shorter focal lengths to zoom out).

Zoom ring

Zoom out

Basic Photography and Playback 49

4 Press the shutter-release button halfway.
Viewfinder photography: Press
Focus point
the shutter-release button
halfway to focus (if the
subject is poorly lit, the
flash may pop up and the
AF-assist illuminator may
light). When the focus
operation is complete, a
In-focus indicator
beep will sound (a beep
may not sound if the subject is moving) and the active focus
point and in-focus indicator (I) will appear in the viewfinder.
In-focus indicator
Description
I
Subject in focus.
Camera unable to focus using autofocus. See
I (flashes)
page 86.

Live view: The focus point flashes green
while the camera focuses. If the
camera is able to focus, the focus
point will be displayed in green;
otherwise, the focus point will flash
red.

50 Basic Photography and Playback

5 Shoot.
Smoothly press the
shutter-release button the
rest of the way down to
take the photograph. The
memory card access lamp
will light and the
photograph will be
displayed in the monitor
for a few seconds. Do not
eject the memory card or
remove or disconnect the
power source until the lamp
has gone out and recording
is complete.

Memory card access
lamp

Rotate the live view switch to exit live
view.

Basic Photography and Playback 51

A The Shutter-Release Button
The camera has a two-stage shutter-release button. The camera
focuses when the shutter-release button is pressed halfway. To take
the photograph, press the shutter-release button the rest of the way
down.

Focus: press halfway

Shoot: press all the
way down
Pressing the shutter-release button halfway also ends playback and
readies the camera for immediate use.

A Automatic Scene Selection (Scene Auto Selector)
If live view is selected in i or j mode, the
camera will automatically analyze the
subject and select the appropriate
shooting mode when the shutter-release
button is pressed halfway to focus using
autofocus. The selected mode is shown in
the monitor.
c
d
e

Portrait
Landscape
Close up

f

Night portrait

Z
b

Auto
Auto (flash off)

Human portrait subjects
Landscapes and cityscapes
Subjects close to the camera
Portrait subjects framed against a dark
background
Subjects suited to i or j mode or that do not
fall into the categories listed above

52 Basic Photography and Playback

A The Standby Timer (Viewfinder Photography)
The viewfinder display will turn off if no operations are
performed for about eight seconds, reducing the drain on
the battery. Press the shutter-release button halfway to
reactivate the display. The length of time before the
standby timer expires automatically can be selected using
Custom Setting c2 (Auto off timers; 0 240).
Exposure meters off

Exposure meters on

A The Standby Timer (Live View)
The monitor will turn off if no operations are performed for about ten
minutes. The length of time before the monitor turns off automatically
can be selected using Custom Setting c2 (Auto off timers; 0 240).

A Live View Zoom Preview
To magnify the view in the monitor up to about 8.3× for precise focus,
press the X button. While the view through the lens is zoomed in, a
navigation window will appear in a gray frame at the bottom right
corner of the display. Use the multi selector to scroll to areas of the
frame not visible in the monitor, or press W (Q) to zoom out.

X button

Navigation window

Basic Photography and Playback 53

A The Built-in Flash
If additional lighting is required for correct
exposure in i mode, the built-in flash will
pop up automatically when the shutterrelease button is pressed halfway (0 101).
If the flash is raised, photographs can only
be taken when the flash-ready indicator (M)
is displayed. If the flash-ready indicator is
not displayed, the flash is charging; remove
your finger briefly from the shutter-release
button and try again.

When the flash is not in use, return it to its
closed position by pressing it gently
downward till the latch clicks into place.

A Exposure
Depending on the scene, exposure may differ from that which would
be obtained when live view is not used.

54 Basic Photography and Playback

D Shooting in Live View Mode
Although they will not appear in the final picture, jagged edges, color
fringing, moiré, and bright spots may appear in the monitor, while
bright regions or bands may appear in some areas with flashing signs
and other intermittent light sources or if the subject is briefly
illuminated by a strobe or other bright, momentary light source. In
addition, distortion may occur with moving subjects, particularly if the
camera is panned horizontally or an object moves horizontally at high
speed through the frame. Flicker and banding visible in the monitor
under fluorescent, mercury vapor, or sodium lamps can be reduced
using Flicker reduction (0 268), although they may still be visible in
the final photograph at some shutter speeds. Avoid pointing the
camera at the sun or other strong light sources. Failure to observe this
precaution could result in damage to the camera’s internal circuitry.
Live view ends automatically when the monitor is closed (closing the
monitor does not end live view on televisions or other external
displays).
To prevent light entering via the viewfinder from appearing in the
photograph or interfering with exposure, we recommend that you
cover the viewfinder with your hand or other objects such as an
optional eyepiece cap before taking pictures without your eye to the
viewfinder (0 80).

A HDMI
When the camera is attached to an HDMI video device, the video
device will display the view through the lens. If the device supports
HDMI-CEC, select Off for the HDMI > Device control option in the
setup menu (0 219) before shooting in live view.

Basic Photography and Playback 55

Basic Playback

1 Press the K button.
A photograph will be displayed in the
monitor.

K button

2 View additional pictures.
Additional pictures can be
displayed by pressing 4 or
2.
To end playback and return to shooting mode, press the
shutter-release button halfway.

56 Basic Photography and Playback

Deleting Unwanted Photographs
To delete the photograph currently displayed in the monitor,
press the O button. Note that photographs can not be recovered
once deleted.

1 Display the photograph.
Display the photograph you wish to
delete.

K button

2 Delete the photograph.
Press the O button. A confirmation
dialog will be displayed; press the O
button again to delete the image and
return to playback.
O button

A Delete
The Delete option in the playback menu can be used to delete
multiple images (0 206).

Basic Photography and Playback 57

Matching Settings to the Subject or
Situation (Scene Mode)
The camera offers a choice of “scene” modes. Choosing a scene
mode automatically optimizes settings to suit the selected
scene, making creative photography as simple as selecting a
mode, framing a picture, and shooting as described on page 47.
The following scenes can be selected by rotating the mode dial
to h and rotating the command dial until the desired scene
appears in the monitor.

+
Mode dial

k
l
p
m
n
o
r
s

Portrait
Landscape
Child
Sports
Close up
Night Portrait
Night Landscape
Party/Indoor

Command dial

t
u
v
w
x
y
z
0

Monitor

Beach/Snow
Sunset
Dusk/Dawn
Pet Portrait
Candlelight
Blossom
Autumn Colors
Food

58 Matching Settings to the Subject or Situation (Scene Mode)

k Portrait
Use for portraits with soft, naturallooking skin tones. If the subject is
far from the background or a
telephoto lens is used, background
details will be softened to lend the
composition a sense of depth.

l Landscape
Use for vivid landscape shots in
daylight.

A Note
The built-in flash and AF-assist illuminator turn off.

p Child
Use for snapshots of children.
Clothing and background details
are vividly rendered, while skin
tones remain soft and natural.

Matching Settings to the Subject or Situation (Scene Mode) 59

m Sports
Fast shutter speeds freeze motion
for dynamic sports shots in which
the main subject stands out clearly.

A Note
The built-in flash and AF-assist illuminator turn off.

n Close up
Use for close-up shots of flowers,
insects, and other small objects (a
macro lens can be used to focus at
very close ranges).

o Night Portrait
Use for a natural balance between
the main subject and the
background in portraits taken
under low light.

60 Matching Settings to the Subject or Situation (Scene Mode)

r Night Landscape
Reduce noise and unnatural colors
when photographing night
landscapes, including street
lighting and neon signs.

A Note
The built-in flash and AF-assist illuminator turn off.

s Party/Indoor
Capture the effects of indoor
background lighting. Use for
parties and other indoor scenes.

t Beach/Snow
Capture the brightness of sunlit
expanses of water, snow, or sand.

A Note
The built-in flash and AF-assist illuminator turn off.

Matching Settings to the Subject or Situation (Scene Mode) 61

u Sunset
Preserves the deep hues seen in
sunsets and sunrises.

A Note
The built-in flash and AF-assist illuminator turn off.

v Dusk/Dawn
Preserves the colors seen in the
weak natural light before dawn or
after sunset.

A Note
The built-in flash and AF-assist illuminator turn off.

w Pet Portrait
Use for portraits of active pets.

A Note
The AF-assist illuminator turns off.

62 Matching Settings to the Subject or Situation (Scene Mode)

x Candlelight
For photographs taken by
candlelight.

A Note
The built-in flash turns off.

y Blossom
Use for fields of flowers, orchards in
bloom, and other landscapes
featuring expanses of blossoms.

A Note
The built-in flash turns off.

z Autumn Colors
Captures the brilliant reds and
yellows in autumn leaves.

A Note
The built-in flash turns off.

Matching Settings to the Subject or Situation (Scene Mode) 63

0 Food
Use for vivid photographs of food.

A Note
For flash photography, press the M (Y) button to raise the flash (0 103).

A Preventing Blur
Use a tripod to prevent blur caused by camera shake at slow shutter
speeds.

64 Matching Settings to the Subject or Situation (Scene Mode)

Special Effects
Special effects can be used when taking photographs and
shooting movies.
The following effects can be selected by rotating the mode dial
to q and rotating the command dial until the desired option
appears in the monitor.

+
Mode dial

%
S
T
U
'

Night Vision
Super Vivid
Pop
Photo Illustration
Toy Camera Effect

Command dial

(
3
1
2
3

Monitor

Miniature Effect
Selective Color
Silhouette
High Key
Low Key

% Night Vision
Use under conditions of darkness to
record monochrome images at high
ISO sensitivities.

A Note
Autofocus is available in live view only; manual focus can be used if the
camera is unable to focus. The built-in flash and AF-assist illuminator
turn off.

Special Effects 65

S Super Vivid
Overall saturation and contrast are
increased for a more vibrant image.

T Pop
Overall saturation is increased for a
more lively image.

U Photo Illustration
Sharpen outlines and simplify
coloring for a poster effect that can
be adjusted in live view (0 70).

A Note
Movies shot in this mode play back like a slide show made up of a series
of stills.

66 Special Effects

' Toy Camera Effect
Create photos and movies that
appear to have been shot with a toy
camera. The effect can be adjusted
in live view (0 71).

( Miniature Effect
Create photos that appear to be
pictures of dioramas. Works best
when shooting from a high vantage
point. Miniature effect movies play
back at high speed, compressing
about 45 minutes of footage shot at
1920 × 1080/30p into a movie that
plays back in about three minutes.
The effect can be adjusted in live
view (0 72).
A Note
Sound is not recorded with movies. The built-in flash and AF-assist
illuminator turn off.

3 Selective Color
All colors other than the selected
colors are recorded in black and
white. The effect can be adjusted in
live view (0 73).

A Note
The built-in flash turns off.

Special Effects 67

1 Silhouette
Silhouette subjects against bright
backgrounds.

A Note
The built-in flash turns off.

2 High Key
Use with bright scenes to create
bright images that seem filled with
light.

A Note
The built-in flash turns off.

3 Low Key
Use with dark scenes to create dark,
low-key images with prominent
highlights.

A Note
The built-in flash turns off.

68 Special Effects

A NEF (RAW)
NEF (RAW) recording is not available in %, S, T, U, ', (, and 3 modes.
Pictures taken when an NEF (RAW) or NEF (RAW)+JPEG option is
selected in these modes will be recorded as JPEG images. JPEG images
created at settings of NEF (RAW)+JPEG will be recorded at the selected
JPEG quality, while images recorded at a setting of NEF (RAW) will be
recorded as fine-quality images.

A U and ( Modes
Autofocus is not available during movie recording. The live view
refresh rate will drop, together with the frame rate for continuous
release modes; using autofocus during live view photography will
disrupt the preview.

A Preventing Blur
Use a tripod to prevent blur caused by camera shake at slow shutter
speeds.

Special Effects 69

Options Available in Live View
Settings for the selected effect are adjusted in the live view
display.

❚❚ U Photo Illustration

1 Select live view.
Rotate the live view switch. The view
through the lens will be displayed in
the monitor.

Live view switch

2 Adjust outline thickness.
Press J to display the options shown
at right. Press 4 or 2 to make
outlines thicker or thinner.

3 Press J.
Press J to exit when settings are complete. To exit live view,
rotate the live view switch.

70 Special Effects

❚❚ ' Toy Camera Effect

1 Select live view.
Rotate the live view switch. The view
through the lens will be displayed in
the monitor.

Live view switch

2 Adjust options.
Press J to display the options shown
at right. Press 1 or 3 to highlight
Vividness or Vignetting and press 4
or 2 to change. Adjust vividness to
make colors more or less saturated,
vignetting to control the amount of vignetting.

3 Press J.
Press J to exit when settings are complete. To exit live view,
rotate the live view switch.

Special Effects 71

❚❚ ( Miniature Effect

1 Select live view.
Rotate the live view switch. The view
through the lens will be displayed in
the monitor.

Live view switch

2 Position the focus point.
Use the multi selector to position the
focus point in the area that will be in
focus and then press the shutterrelease button halfway to focus. To
temporarily clear miniature effect
options from the display and enlarge the view in the monitor
for precise focus, press X. Press W (Q) to restore the
miniature effect display.

3 Display options.
Press J to display miniature effect
options.

4 Adjust options.
Press 4 or 2 to choose the
orientation of the area that will be in
focus and press 1 or 3 to adjust its
width.

72 Special Effects

5 Press J.
Press J to exit when settings are complete. To exit live view,
rotate the live view switch.

❚❚ 3 Selective Color

1 Select live view.
Rotate the live view switch. The view
through the lens will be displayed in
the monitor.

Live view switch

2 Display options.
Press J to display selective color
options.

3 Select a color.

Selected color

Frame an object in the white square in
the center of the display and press 1
to choose the color of the object as
one that will remain in the final image
(the camera may have difficulty
detecting unsaturated colors; choose
a saturated color). To zoom in on the center of the display for
more precise color selection, press X. Press W (Q) to zoom
out.

Special Effects 73

4 Choose the color range.

Color range

Press 1 or 3 to increase or decrease
the range of similar hues that will be
included in the final image. Choose
from values between 1 and 7; note
that higher values may include hues
from other colors.

5 Select additional colors.
To select additional colors, rotate the
command dial to highlight another of
the three color boxes at the top of the
display and repeat Steps 3 and 4 to
select another color. Repeat for a
third color if desired. To deselect the highlighted color, press
O (To remove all colors, press and hold O. A confirmation
dialog will be displayed; select Yes).

6 Press J.
Press J to exit when settings are complete. During shooting,
only objects of the selected hues will be recorded in color; all
others will be recorded in black-and-white. To exit live view,
rotate the live view switch.

74 Special Effects

More on Photography
Choosing a Release Mode
To choose how the shutter is released
(release mode), press the I (E) button,
then highlight the desired option and
press J.

I (E) button

Mode
8
!
9
J
E

Description
Single frame: Camera takes one photograph each time shutterrelease button is pressed.
Continuous L: The camera takes photographs at a slow rate while
the shutter-release button is pressed (0 76).
Continuous H: The camera takes photographs at a fast rate while
the shutter-release button is pressed (0 76).
Quiet shutter release: As for single-frame, except that camera noise
is reduced (0 78).
Self-timer: Take pictures with the self-timer (0 79).

A Choosing a Release Mode with the Command Dial
The release mode can also be selected by keeping the I (E) button
pressed while rotating the command dial. Release the I (E) button
to select the highlighted option and return to the information display.

More on Photography 75

Continuous Shooting (Burst Mode)
In ! (Continuous L) and 9 (Continuous H) modes, the
camera takes photographs continuously while the shutterrelease button is pressed all the way down.

1 Press the I (E) button.

I (E) button

2 Choose a continuous release mode.
Highlight ! (Continuous L) or
9 (Continuous H) and press J.

3 Focus.
Frame the shot and focus.

4 Take photographs.
The camera will take photographs
while the shutter-release button is
pressed all the way down.

76 More on Photography

A The Memory Buffer
The camera is equipped with a memory buffer for temporary storage,
allowing shooting to continue while photographs are being saved to
the memory card. Up to 100 photographs can be taken in succession
(an exception is if a shutter speed of 4 seconds or slower is selected in
mode S or M, when there is no limit on the number of shots that can be
taken in a single burst). If the battery is exhausted while images
remain in the buffer, the shutter release will be disabled and the
images transferred to the memory card.

A Frame Rate
For information on the number of photographs can be taken in
continuous release modes, see page 357. Frame rates may drop when
the memory buffer is full or the battery is low.

A The Built-in Flash
Continuous release modes can not be used with the built-in flash;
rotate the mode dial to j (0 47) or turn the flash off (0 102).

A Buffer Size
The approximate number of images that
can be stored in the memory buffer at
current settings is shown in the viewfinder exposure-count display
while the shutter-release button is pressed.

More on Photography 77

Quiet Shutter Release
Choose this mode to keep camera noise to a minimum. A beep
does not sound when the camera focuses.

1 Press the I (E) button.

I (E) button

2 Select J (Quiet shutter release).
Highlight J (Quiet shutter release)
and press J.

3 Take pictures.
Press the shutter-release button all
the way down to shoot.

78 More on Photography

Self-Timer Mode
The self-timer can be used for self-portraits or group shots that
include the photographer. Before proceeding, mount the
camera on a tripod or place it on a stable, level surface.

1 Press the I (E) button.

I (E) button

2 Select E (Self-timer) mode.
Highlight E (Self-timer) and press J.

3 Frame the photograph.

More on Photography 79

4 Take the photograph.
Press the shutter-release button
halfway to focus, and then press the
button the rest of the way down. The
self-timer lamp will start to flash and a
beep will begin to sound. Two
seconds before the photo is taken, the
lamp will stop flashing and the
beeping will become more rapid. The
shutter will be released ten seconds
after the timer starts.
Note that the timer may not start or a photograph may not be
taken if the camera is unable to focus or in other situations in
which the shutter can not be released. To stop the timer
without taking a photograph, turn the camera off.

A Cover the Viewfinder
To prevent light entering via the viewfinder from appearing in the
photograph or interfering with exposure, we recommend that you
cover the viewfinder with your hand or other objects such as an
optional eyepiece cap (0 322) when taking pictures without your eye
to the viewfinder. To attach the cap, remove the rubber eyecup (q)
and insert the cap as shown (w). Hold the camera firmly when
removing the rubber eyecup.
Rubber eyecup

80 More on Photography

Eyepiece cap

A Using the Built-in Flash
Before taking a photograph with the flash in modes that require the
flash to be raised manually, press the M (Y) button to raise the flash
and wait for the M indicator to be displayed in the viewfinder (0 54).
Shooting will be interrupted if the flash is raised after the self-timer has
started.

A Custom Setting c3 (Self-Timer)
For information on choosing the duration of the self-timer and the
number of shots taken, see Custom Setting c3 (Self-timer; 0 241).

More on Photography 81

Focus
Focus can be adjusted automatically (see below) or manually
(0 95). The user can also select the focus point for automatic or
manual focus (0 90) or use focus lock to focus to recompose
photographs after focusing (0 93).

Focus Mode
The following focus modes can be selected during viewfinder
photography:
Option

Description
Camera automatically selects single-servo
autofocus if subject is stationary, continuousAF-A Auto-servo AF
servo autofocus if subject is moving. Shutter
can only be released if camera is able to focus.
For stationary subjects. Focus locks when
shutter-release button is pressed halfway.
AF-S Single-servo AF
Shutter can only be released if camera is able
to focus.
For moving subjects. Camera focuses
continuously while shutter-release button is
pressed halfway. At default settings, shutter
ContinuousAF-C
can only be released if camera is able to focus,
servo AF
but Custom Setting a1 (AF-C priority
selection, 0 235) can be changed to allow the
shutter to be released at any time.
MF Manual focus
Focus manually (0 95).

Note that AF-S and AF-C are available only in modes P, S, A, and M.

82 More on Photography

The following focus modes are available in live view:
Option

AF-S Single-servo AF

AF-F

Full-time-servo
AF

MF Manual focus

Description
For stationary subjects. Focus locks when
shutter-release button is pressed halfway.
You can also focus by touching your subject
in the monitor, in which case focus locks until
you lift your finger from the display to take
the photograph.
For moving subjects. Camera focuses
continuously until shutter-release button is
pressed. Focus locks when shutter-release
button is pressed halfway. You can also focus
by touching your subject in the monitor, in
which case focus locks until you lift your
finger from the display to take the
photograph.
Focus manually (0 95).

Note that full-time–servo AF is not available in U, ', and (
modes.

More on Photography 83

❚❚ Choosing the Focus Mode
Follow the steps below to choose the focus mode.

1 Display focus mode options.
Press the P button, then highlight the
current focus mode in the information
display and press J.
P button

Viewfinder photography

Live view

2 Choose a focus mode.
Highlight a focus mode and press J.

Viewfinder photography

84 More on Photography

Live view

A Predictive Focus Tracking
In AF-C mode or when continuous-servo autofocus is selected in AF-A
mode during viewfinder photography, the camera will initiate
predictive focus tracking if the subject moves toward the camera while
the shutter-release button is pressed halfway. This allows the camera
to track focus while attempting to predict where the subject will be
when the shutter is released.

D Continuous-Servo Autofocus
When Focus is selected for Custom Setting a1 (AF-C priority
selection; 0 235) and the camera is in AF-C mode or continuous-servo
autofocus is selected in AF-A mode, the camera gives higher priority to
focus response (has a wider focus range) than in AF-S mode, and the
shutter may be released before the in-focus indicator (I) is displayed.

A The AF-Assist Illuminator
If the subject is poorly lit, the AF-assist
illuminator will light automatically to assist
the autofocus operation when the shutterrelease button is pressed halfway (some
restrictions apply; 0 342). Note that the
illuminator may become hot when used
multiple times in quick succession and will
turn off automatically to protect the lamp
after a period of continuous use. Normal
function will resume after a brief pause.

AF-assist illuminator

More on Photography 85

A Getting Good Results with Autofocus
Autofocus does not perform well under the conditions listed below.
The shutter release may be disabled if the camera is unable to focus
under these conditions, or the in-focus indicator (I) may be displayed
and the camera may sound a beep, allowing the shutter to be released
even when the subject is not in focus. In these cases, focus manually
(0 95) or use focus lock (0 93) to focus on another subject at the same
distance and then recompose the photograph.
There is little or no contrast between the subject and
the background.
Example: Subject is the same color as the
background.
The focus point contains objects at different
distances from the camera.
Example: Subject is inside a cage.

The subject is dominated by regular geometric
patterns.
Example: Blinds or a row of windows in a
skyscraper.
The focus point contains areas of sharply
contrasting brightness.
Example: Subject is half in the shade.

Background objects appear larger than the subject.
Example: A building is in the frame behind the
subject.

The subject contains many fine details.
Example: A field of flowers or other subjects that
are small or lack variation in brightness.

86 More on Photography

AF-Area Mode
Choose how the focus point for autofocus is selected. The
following options are available during viewfinder photography:
Option

Description
For stationary subjects. Focus point is selected
c Single-point AF manually; camera focuses on subject in
selected focus point only.
For non-stationary subjects. In AF-A and AF-C
focus modes, user selects focus point using multi
Dynamic-area AF selector (0 90), but camera will focus based
J
on information from surrounding focus points
(9 points)
if subject briefly leaves selected point.
Number of focus points varies with mode
selected:
9-point dynamic-area AF: Choose when there is
time to compose photograph or when
Dynamic-area AF photographing subjects that are moving
K
(21 points)
predictably (e.g., runners or race cars on a
track).
21-point dynamic-area AF: Choose when
photographing subjects that are moving
unpredictably (e.g., players at a football
game).
Dynamic-area AF
L
39-point dynamic-area AF: Choose when
(39 points)
photographing subjects that are moving
quickly and are hard to keep in frame (e.g.,
birds).

More on Photography 87

Option

f 3D-tracking

e Auto-area AF

Description
In AF-A and AF-C focus modes, user selects focus
point using multi selector (0 90). If subject
moves after camera has focused, camera uses
3D-tracking to select new focus point and
keep focus locked on original subject while
shutter-release button is pressed halfway.

Camera automatically detects subject and
selects focus point.

Note that d (dynamic-area) and f (3D-tracking) AF-area
modes are not available when AF-S is selected for focus mode.

A 3D-Tracking
If subject leaves the viewfinder, remove your finger from the shutterrelease button and recompose the photograph with the subject in the
selected focus point. Note that when the shutter-release button is
pressed halfway, the colors in the area surrounding the focus point are
stored in the camera. Consequently 3D-tracking may not produce the
desired results with subjects that are similar in color to the background
or that occupy a very small area of the frame.

88 More on Photography

In modes other than i, j, and (, the following AF-area modes
can be selected in live view:
Option

Description
Use for portraits. The
camera automatically
detects and focuses on
portrait subjects; the
selected subject is
indicated by a double
Face6
yellow border (if multiple
priority AF
faces are detected, the camera will focus on the
closest subject; to choose a different subject, use the
multi selector). If the camera can no longer detect
the subject (because, for example, the subject has
turned to face away from the camera), the border will
no longer be displayed.
Use for hand-held shots of
landscapes and other nonWide-area portrait subjects.
7
AF

8

Normalarea AF

Use for pin-point focus on
a selected spot in the
frame. A tripod is
recommended.

More on Photography 89

Option

Description
Use the multi selector to
position the focus point
over your subject and
press J to start tracking.
The focus point will track
the selected subject as it
Subjectmoves through the frame.
9
tracking AF
To end tracking, press J again. Note that the camera
may be unable to track subjects if they move quickly,
leave the frame or are obscured by other objects,
change visibly in size, color, or brightness, or are too
small, too large, too bright, too dark, or similar in
color or brightness to the background.

Note that subject-tracking AF is not available in %, U, ', and 3
modes.

A Manual Focus-Point Selection
The multi selector can be used to select the focus point. Except in
subject-tracking AF, pressing J during focus-point selection selects
the center focus point. In subject-tracking AF, pressing J starts
subject tracking instead. Manual focus-point selection is not available
in auto-area AF.

90 More on Photography

❚❚ Choosing the AF-Area Mode
Follow the steps below to choose the AF-area mode.

1 Display AF-area mode options.
Press the P button, then highlight the
current AF-area mode in the
information display and press J.
P button

Viewfinder photography

Live view

2 Choose an AF-area mode.
Highlight an option and press J.

Viewfinder photography

Live view

A AF-Area Mode
AF-area mode selections made in shooting modes other than P, S, A, or
M are reset when another shooting mode is selected.

More on Photography 91

D Using Autofocus in Live View
The desired results may not be achieved with teleconverters (0 305).
Note that in live view, autofocus is slower and the monitor may
brighten or darken while the camera focuses. The focus point may
sometimes be displayed in green when the camera is unable to focus.
The camera may be unable to focus in the following situations:
• The subject contains lines parallel to the long edge of the frame
• The subject lacks contrast
• The subject in the focus point contains areas of sharply contrasting
brightness, or includes spot lighting or a neon sign or other light
source that changes in brightness
• Flicker or banding appears under fluorescent, mercury-vapor,
sodium-vapor, or similar lighting
• A cross (star) filter or other special filter is used
• The subject appears smaller than the focus point
• The subject is dominated by regular geometric patterns (e.g., blinds
or a row of windows in a skyscraper)
• The subject is moving

92 More on Photography

Focus Lock
Focus lock can be used to change the composition after focusing
in AF-A, AF-S, and AF-C focus modes (0 82), making it possible to
focus on a subject that will not be in a focus point in the final
composition. If the camera is unable to focus using autofocus
(0 86), focus lock can also be used to recompose the
photograph after focusing on another object at the same
distance as your original subject. Focus lock is most effective
when an option other than e (Auto-area AF) is selected for AFarea mode (0 87).

1 Focus.
Position the subject in the selected focus point
and press the shutter-release button halfway to
initiate focus. Check that the in-focus indicator (I)
appears in the viewfinder (viewfinder photography) or that
the focus point has turned green (live view).

Viewfinder photography

Live view

A Autoexposure Lock
Pressing the A (L) button in Step 2 also locks exposure (0 130).

More on Photography 93

2 Lock focus.
AF-A and AF-C focus modes (viewfinder
photography): With the shutter-release
button pressed halfway (q), press the
A (L) button (w) to lock focus.
Focus will remain locked while the
A (L) button is pressed, even if you
later remove your finger from the
shutter-release button.

Shutter-release button

A (L) button

AF-S (viewfinder photography) and live view: Focus locks
automatically and remain locked until you remove your
finger from the shutter-release button. Focus can also be
locked by pressing the A (L) button (see above).

3 Recompose the photograph and shoot.
Focus will remain locked between shots if you
keep the shutter-release button pressed halfway
or keep the A (L) button pressed, allowing
several photographs in succession to be taken at the same
focus setting.
Do not change the distance between the camera and the
subject while focus lock is in effect. If the subject moves,
focus again at the new distance.

Viewfinder photography

94 More on Photography

Live view

Manual Focus
Manual focus can be used when autofocus is not available or
does not produce the desired results (0 86).

1 Select manual focus.
If the lens is equipped with an A-M, M/A-M, or A/M-M mode
switch, slide the switch to M.
A-M mode switch

M/A-M mode switch

If the lens is not equipped a focus-mode switch, select MF
(manual focus) for Focus mode (0 82).

2 Focus.
To focus manually, adjust the lens
focus ring until the image displayed
on the clear matte field in the
viewfinder is in focus. Photographs
can be taken at any time, even when
the image is not in focus.

A AF-P Lenses
When an AF-P lens (0 305) is used in manual focus mode, the in-focus
indicator (I) will flash in the viewfinder (or in live view, the focus point
will flash in the monitor) to warn that continuing to rotate the focus
ring in the current direction will not bring the subject into focus.

More on Photography 95

❚❚ The Electronic Rangefinder (Viewfinder Photography)
The viewfinder focus indicator can be
used to confirm whether the subject in
the selected focus point is in focus (the
focus point can be selected from any of
the 39 focus points). After positioning
the subject in the selected focus point,
press the shutter-release button halfway
and rotate the lens focus ring until the in-focus indicator (I) is
displayed. Note that with the subjects listed on page 86, the infocus indicator may sometimes be displayed when the subject is
not in focus; confirm focus in the viewfinder before shooting.

A Selecting Manual Focus with the Camera
If the lens supports M/A (autofocus with
manual override) or A/M (autofocus with
manual override/AF priority), manual focus
can also be selected by setting the camera
focus mode to MF (manual focus; 0 82).
Focus can then be adjusted manually,
regardless of the mode selected with the
lens.

A Focal Plane Position
To determine the distance between your
subject and the camera, measure from
the focal plane mark (E) on the camera
body. The distance between the lens
mounting flange and the focal plane is
46.5 mm (1.83 in.).

46.5 mm

Focal plane mark

96 More on Photography

A Live View
Press the X button to zoom in for precise
focus in live view (0 53).

X button

More on Photography 97

Image Quality and Size
Together, image quality and size determine how much space
each photograph occupies on the memory card. Larger, higher
quality images can be printed at larger sizes but also require
more memory, meaning that fewer such images can be stored
on the memory card (0 387).

Image Quality
Choose a file format and compression ratio (image quality).
Option
File type
NEF (RAW) +
JPEG fine
NEF (RAW) + NEF/
JPEG normal JPEG
NEF (RAW) +
JPEG basic
NEF (RAW)

NEF

JPEG fine
JPEG normal

JPEG

JPEG basic

Description
Two images are recorded: one NEF (RAW) image
and one fine-quality JPEG image.
Two images are recorded: one NEF (RAW) image
and one normal-quality JPEG image.
Two images are recorded: one NEF (RAW) image
and one basic-quality JPEG image.
Raw data from the image sensor are saved
without additional processing. Settings such as
white balance and contrast can be adjusted after
shooting.
Record JPEG images at a compression ratio of
roughly 1 : 4 (fine quality).
Record JPEG images at a compression ratio of
roughly 1 : 8 (normal quality).
Record JPEG images at a compression ratio of
roughly 1 : 16 (basic quality).

A NEF (RAW) + JPEG
When photographs taken at NEF (RAW) + JPEG are viewed on the
camera, only the JPEG image will be displayed. When photographs
taken at these settings are deleted, both NEF and JPEG images will be
deleted.

98 More on Photography

1 Display image quality options.
Press the P button, then highlight the
current image quality in the
information display and press J.
P button

Information display

2 Choose a file type.
Highlight an option and press J.

A NEF (RAW) Images
Selecting NEF (RAW) for Image quality fixes Image size at Large
(0 100). White balance bracketing (0 151), high dynamic range (HDR,
0 138), and Date stamp (0 243) are not available at image quality
settings of NEF (RAW) or NEF (RAW)+JPEG.

A Converting NEF (RAW) Images to Other Formats
JPEG copies of NEF (RAW) images can be created using the NEF (RAW)
processing option in the retouch menu (0 280) or software such as
Capture NX-D (0 210).

More on Photography 99

Image Size
Image size is measured in pixels. Choose from # Large,
$ Medium, or % Small:
Image size
Size (pixels)
Print size (cm/in.) *
# Large
6000 × 4000
50.8 × 33.9/20 × 13.3
$ Medium
4496 × 3000
38.1 × 25.4/15.0 × 10
% Small
2992 × 2000
25.3 × 16.9/10 × 6.7
* Approximate size when printed at 300 dpi. Print size in inches equals
image size in pixels divided by printer resolution in dots per inch (dpi;
1 inch=approximately 2.54 cm).

1 Display image size options.
Press the P button, then highlight the
current image size in the information
display and press J.
P button

Information display

2 Choose an image size.
Highlight an option and press J.

100 More on Photography

Using the Built-in Flash
The camera supports a variety of flash modes for photographing
poorly lit or backlit subjects.

Auto Pop-up Modes
In i, k, p, n, o, s, w, S, T, U, and ' modes, the built-in flash
automatically pops up and fires as required.

1 Choose a flash mode.
Keeping the M (Y) button pressed, rotate the command dial
until the desired flash mode appears in the information
display.

+
M (Y) button

Command dial

Information display

2 Take pictures.
The flash will pop up as
required when the shutterrelease button is pressed
halfway, and fire when a
photograph is taken. If the
flash does not pop up
automatically, DO NOT attempt to raise it by hand. Failure to
observe this precaution could damage the flash.

More on Photography 101

❚❚ Flash Modes
The following flash modes are available:
• No (auto): When lighting is poor or the subject is backlit,
the flash pops up automatically when the shutter-release
button is pressed halfway and fires as required. Not available
in o mode.
• Njo (auto + red-eye reduction): Use for portraits. The
flash pops up and fires as required, but before it fires the redeye reduction lamp lights to help reduce “red-eye.” Not
available in o mode.
• Njr (auto slow sync + red-eye): As for auto with red-eye
reduction, except that slow shutter speeds are used to
capture background lighting. Use for portraits taken at night
or under low light. Available in o mode.
• Nr (auto slow sync): Slow shutter speeds are used to
capture background lighting in shots taken at night or under
low light. Available in o mode.
• j (flash off ): The flash does not fire.

A The Information Display
Flash mode can also be selected in the
information display (0 6).

102 More on Photography

Manual Pop-up Modes
In P, S, A, M, and 0 modes, the flash must be raised manually. The
flash will not fire if it is not raised.

1 Raise the flash.
Press the M (Y) button to raise the
flash.

M (Y) button

2 Choose a flash mode (P, S, A, and M modes only).
Keeping the M (Y) button pressed, rotate the command dial
until the desired flash mode appears in the information
display.

+
M (Y) button

Command dial

Information display

3 Take pictures.
The flash will fire whenever a picture is taken.

More on Photography 103

❚❚ Flash Modes
The following flash modes are available:
• N (fill flash): The flash fires with every shot.
• Nj (red-eye reduction): Use for portraits. The flash fires with
every shot, but before it fires, the red-eye reduction lamp
lights to help reduce “red-eye.” Not available in 0 mode.
• Njp (slow sync + red-eye): As for “red-eye reduction”,
above, except that shutter speed slows automatically to
capture background lighting at night or under low light. Use
when you want to include background lighting in portraits.
Not available in modes S, M, and 0.
• Np (slow sync): As for “fill flash”, above, except that
shutter speed slows automatically to capture background
lighting at night or under low light. Use when you want to
capture both subject and background. Not available in
modes S, M, and 0.
• Nt (rear-curtain + slow sync): As for “rear-curtain sync”,
below, except that shutter speed slows automatically to
capture background lighting at night or under low light. Use
when you want to capture both subject and background. Not
available in modes S, M, and 0.
• Nq (rear-curtain sync): The flash fires just before the
shutter closes, creating a stream of light behind moving light
sources as shown below at right. Not available in modes P, A,
and 0.

Front-curtain sync

104 More on Photography

Rear-curtain sync

A Lowering the Built-in Flash
To save power when the flash is not in use,
press it gently downward until the latch
clicks into place.

A The Built-in Flash
For information on the lenses that can be used with the built-in flash,
see page 312. Remove lens hoods to prevent shadows. The flash has a
minimum range of about 0.6 m (2 ft) and can not be used in the macro
range of zoom lenses with a macro function.
The shutter release may be briefly disabled to protect the flash after it
has been used for several consecutive shots. The flash can be used
again after a short pause.

More on Photography 105

A Shutter Speeds Available with the Built-in Flash
Shutter speed is restricted to the following ranges when the built-in
flash is used:
Mode
i, p, n, s, w, 0, S, T, U, '
k
o
P, S, A
M

Shutter speed
1/200–1/60 s
1/200–1/30 s
1/200–1 s
1/200–30 s
1/200–30 s, Bulb, Time

A Aperture, Sensitivity, and Flash Range
Flash range varies with sensitivity (ISO equivalency) and aperture.
100
1.4
2
2.8
4
5.6
8
11
16

200
2
2.8
4
5.6
8
11
16
22

Aperture at ISO equivalent of
Approximate range
400 800 1600 3200 6400 12800
m
ft
2.8
4
5.6
8
11
16
1.0–8.5 3ft 4in.–27ft 10in.
4
5.6
8
11
16
22
0.7–6.0 2ft 4in.–19ft 8in.
5.6
8
11
16
22
32
0.6–4.2
2ft–13ft 9in.
8
11
16
22
32
— 0.6–3.0
2ft–9ft 10in.
11
16
22
32 — — 0.6–2.1
2ft–6ft 10in.
16
22
32 — — — 0.6–1.5
2ft–4ft 11in.
22
32 — — — — 0.6–1.1
2ft–3ft 7in.
32 — — — — — 0.6–0.7
2ft–2ft 4in.

106 More on Photography

ISO Sensitivity
The camera’s sensitivity to light can be adjusted according to the
amount of light available. The higher the ISO sensitivity, the less
light needed to make an exposure, allowing higher shutter
speeds or smaller apertures. Choosing Auto allows the camera
to set ISO sensitivity automatically in response to lighting
conditions; to use auto in P, S, A, and M modes, select Auto ISO
sensitivity control for the ISO sensitivity settings item in the
shooting menu (0 228).
Mode
i, j, %
P, S, A, M
Other shooting modes

ISO sensitivity
Auto
100–25600 in steps of 1/3 EV
Auto; 100–25600 in steps of 1/3 EV

1 Display ISO sensitivity options.
Press the P button, then highlight
the current ISO sensitivity in the
information display and press J.
P button

Information display

More on Photography 107

2 Choose an ISO sensitivity.
Highlight an option and press J.

108 More on Photography

Interval Timer Photography
The camera is equipped to take photographs automatically at
preset intervals.
D Before Shooting
Before beginning interval timer photography, take a test shot at
current settings and view the results in the monitor. To ensure that
shooting starts at the desired time, check that the camera clock is set
correctly (0 262).
Use of a tripod is recommended. Mount the camera on a tripod before
shooting begins. To ensure that shooting is not interrupted, be sure
the battery is fully charged.

1 Select Interval timer shooting.
Highlight Interval timer shooting in
the shooting menu and press 2 to
display interval timer settings.

More on Photography 109

2 Adjust interval timer settings.
Choose a start option, interval, number of shots, and
exposure smoothing option.
• To choose a start option:

Highlight Start options and
press 2.

Highlight an option and
press J.

To start shooting immediately, select Now. To start
shooting at a chosen date and time, select Choose start
day and start time, then choose the date and time and
press J.
• To choose the interval between shots:

Highlight Interval and
press 2.

110 More on Photography

Choose an interval (hours,
minutes, and seconds) and
press J.

• To choose the number of intervals:

Highlight Number of times
and press 2.

Choose the number of intervals
and press J.

• To enable or disable exposure smoothing:

Highlight Exposure
smoothing and press 2.

Highlight an option and
press J.

Selecting On allows the camera to adjust exposure to match
previous shot in modes other than M (note that exposure
smoothing only takes effect in mode M if auto ISO sensitivity
control is on).

More on Photography 111

3 Start shooting.
Highlight Start and press J. The first
shot will be taken at the specified
starting time, or after about 3 s if Now
was selected for Start options in Step
2. Shooting will continue at the
selected interval until all shots have been taken; while
shooting is in progress, the memory card access lamp will
flash at regular intervals. Note that because shutter speed
and the time needed to record the image to the memory card
may vary from shot to shot, intervals may be skipped if the
camera is still in the process of recording the previous
interval; choose an interval longer than the slowest
anticipated shutter speed. If shooting can not proceed at
current settings (for example, if a shutter speed of “Bulb” or
“Time” is currently selected in shooting mode M, the interval
is zero, or the start time is in less than a minute), a warning
will be displayed in the monitor.

112 More on Photography

❚❚ Pausing Interval Timer Photography
Interval timer photography can be paused between intervals by
pressing J. To resume shooting:

Starting Now

Highlight Restart and
press J.

Starting at a Specified Time

For Start options,
highlight Choose start
day and start time
and press 2.

Choose a starting date
and time and press J.

Highlight Restart and
press J.

❚❚ Ending Interval Timer Shooting
To end interval timer photography and resume normal shooting
before all the photos are taken, pause shooting and select Off in
the interval timer menu.

More on Photography 113

❚❚ No Photograph
The camera will skip the current interval if any of the following
situations persist for eight seconds or more after the interval was
due to start: the photograph for the previous interval has yet to
be taken, the memory card is full, or the camera is unable to
focus (AF-S, AF-A with single-servo AF selected, or AF-C with Focus
selected for Custom Setting a1 AF-C priority selection; note
that the camera focuses again before each shot). Shooting will
resume with the next interval.

D Out of Memory
If the memory card is full, the interval timer will remain active but no
pictures will be taken. Resume shooting (0 113) after deleting some
pictures or turning the camera off and inserting another memory card.

A Cover the Viewfinder
To prevent light entering via the viewfinder from appearing in the
photograph or interfering with exposure, we recommend that you
cover the viewfinder with your hand or other objects such as an
optional eyepiece cap (0 322) before taking pictures without your eye
to the viewfinder (0 80).

A Other Settings
Settings can not be adjusted during interval timer photography.
Regardless of the release mode selected, the camera takes one
photograph at each interval; in mode J, camera noise will be reduced.
Bracketing (0 151) and high dynamic range (HDR; 0 138) can not be
used.

A Interrupting Interval Timer Photography
To interrupt interval timer shooting, turn the camera off or rotate the
mode dial to a new setting. Returning the monitor to the storage
position does not interrupt interval timer shooting.

114 More on Photography

Restoring Default Settings
The camera settings listed below
and on page 117 can be restored
to default values by holding the
G and R buttons down
together for more than two
seconds (these buttons are
G button
R button
marked by a green dot). The
information display turns off briefly while settings are reset.

❚❚ Settings Accessible from the Information Display
Option
Image quality
Image size
Auto bracketing
P, S, A, M
HDR (high dynamic range)
P, S, A, M
Active D-Lighting
P, S, A, M
White balance
P, S, A, M
ISO sensitivity
P, S, A, M
Other shooting modes
Picture Control settings
P, S, A, M
1 Fine-tuning is also reset.
2 Current Picture Control only.

Default
JPEG normal
Large

0
98
100

Off

151

Off

138

Auto

136

Auto 1

140

100
Auto

107

Unmodified 2

158

More on Photography 115

Option
Focus mode
Viewfinder
Shooting modes other than %
Live view/movie
AF-area mode
Viewfinder
n, x, 0, 1, 2, 3
m, w
i, j, k, l, p, o, r, s, t, u, v, y, z, S,
T, U, ', 3, P, S, A, M
Live view/movie
k, l, p, o, s, t, u, v, x, y, z
m, r, w, %, S, T, U, ', 3, 1, 2, 3, P, S,
A, M
n, 0
Metering
P, S, A, M
Flash mode
i, k, p, n, w, S, T, '
o
s
U
P, S, A, M
Flash compensation
h, P, S, A, M
Exposure compensation
h, %, P, S, A, M

116 More on Photography

Default

0

AF-A
AF-S

82
83

Single-point AF
Dynamic-area AF (39 points)

87

Auto-area AF
Face-priority AF
Wide-area AF

89

Normal-area AF
Matrix metering

128

Auto
Auto slow sync
Auto+red-eye reduction
Flash off
Fill flash

102,
104

Off

134

Off

132

❚❚ Other Settings
Option
NEF (RAW) recording
Exposure delay mode
Release mode
m, w
Other shooting modes
Focus point
AE/AF lock hold
Shooting modes other than i and j
Flexible program
P
Special effects mode
U
Outlines
'
Vividness
Vignetting
(
Orientation
Width
3
Color
Color range

Default
14-bit
Off
Continuous H
Single frame
Center

0
227
241
75
90

Off

254

Off

120

70
0
0

71

Landscape
Normal

72

Off
3

73

More on Photography 117

P, S, A, and M Modes
Shutter Speed and Aperture
P, S, A, and M modes offer different degrees of
control over shutter speed and aperture:

Mode

P

S

A

M

Description
Recommended for snapshots and in other
situations in which there is little time to
Programmed auto
adjust camera settings. Camera sets
(0 119)
shutter speed and aperture for optimal
exposure.
Use to freeze or blur motion. User chooses
Shutter-priority auto
shutter speed; camera selects aperture for
(0 121)
best results.
Use to blur background or bring both
Aperture-priority auto foreground and background into focus.
User chooses aperture; camera selects
(0 122)
shutter speed for best results.
User controls both shutter speed and
Manual (0 123)
aperture. Set shutter speed to “Bulb” or
“Time” for long time-exposures.

118 P, S, A, and M Modes

Mode P (Programmed Auto)
This mode is recommended
Mode dial
for snapshots or whenever
you want to leave the camera
in charge of shutter speed and
aperture. The camera
automatically adjusts shutter
speed and aperture for
optimal exposure in most
situations.
To take pictures in programmed auto mode, rotate the mode
dial to P.

P, S, A, and M Modes 119

A Flexible Program
In mode P, different combinations of shutter speed and aperture can
be selected by rotating the command dial (“flexible program”). Rotate
the dial right for large apertures (low f-numbers) and fast shutter
speeds, left for small apertures (high f-numbers) and slow shutter
speeds. All combinations produce the same exposure.
Rotate right to blur background details or
freeze motion.

Command dial
Rotate left to increase depth of field or blur
motion.

While flexible program is in effect, a U (R)
indicator appears in the viewfinder and
information display. To restore default
shutter speed and aperture settings, rotate
the command dial until the indicator is no
longer displayed, choose another mode, or
turn the camera off.

120 P, S, A, and M Modes

Mode S (Shutter-Priority Auto)
This mode lets you control shutter speed: choose fast shutter
speeds to “freeze” motion, slow shutter speeds to suggest
motion by blurring moving objects. The camera automatically
adjusts aperture for optimal exposure.

Fast shutter speeds (e.g., 1/1600 s)
freeze motion.

Slow shutter speeds (e.g., 1 s) blur
motion.

To choose a shutter speed:

1 Rotate the mode dial to S.

Mode dial

2 Choose a shutter speed.
Rotate the command dial to choose the desired shutter
speed: rotate right for faster speeds, left for slower speeds.

Command dial

P, S, A, and M Modes 121

Mode A (Aperture-Priority Auto)
In this mode, you can adjust aperture to control depth of field
(the distance in front of and behind the main subject that
appears to be in focus). The camera automatically adjusts
shutter speed for optimal exposure.

Large apertures (low f-numbers, e.g. Small apertures (high f-numbers, e.g.
f/5.6) blur details in front of and
f/22) bring the foreground and
behind the main subject.
background into focus.

To choose an aperture:

1 Rotate the mode dial to A.

Mode dial

2 Choose an aperture.
Rotate the command dial left for larger apertures (lower fnumbers), right for smaller apertures (higher f-numbers).

Command dial

122 P, S, A, and M Modes

Mode M (Manual)
In manual mode, you control both shutter speed and aperture.
Shutter speeds of “Bulb” and “Time” are available for long timeexposures of moving lights, the stars, night scenery, or fireworks
(0 125).

1 Rotate the mode dial to M.

Mode dial

P, S, A, and M Modes 123

2 Choose aperture and shutter speed.
Checking the exposure indicator (see below), adjust shutter
speed and aperture. Shutter speed is selected by rotating the
command dial (right for faster speeds, left for slower). To
adjust aperture, keep the E (N) button pressed while
rotating the command dial (left for larger apertures/lower
f-numbers and right for smaller apertures/higher f-numbers).
Shutter speed

Command dial

Aperture

E (N) button

Command dial

A The Exposure Indicator
If a CPU lens is attached (0 305) and a shutter speed other than “Bulb”
or “Time” is selected, the exposure indicator in the viewfinder and
information display shows whether the photograph would be underor over-exposed at current settings.
Optimal exposure

124 P, S, A, and M Modes

Underexposed by 1/3 EV

Overexposed by over 2 EV

Long Time-Exposures (M Mode Only)
Select the following shutter
speeds for long time-exposures
of moving lights, the stars, night
scenery, or fireworks.
• Bulb (A): The shutter
remains open while the
Shutter speed: A (35-second
shutter-release button is
exposure; 0 126)
pressed all the way down. To
Aperture: f/25
prevent blur, use a tripod or an
optional wireless remote controller (0 323) or remote cord
(0 324).
• Time (&): Start the exposure using the shutter-release button
on the camera or on a remote cord or wireless remote
controller. The shutter remains open until the button is
pressed a second time.
Before proceeding, mount the camera on a tripod or place it on
a stable, level surface. To prevent light entering via the
viewfinder from appearing in the photograph or interfering with
exposure, we recommend that you cover the viewfinder with
your hand or other objects such as an optional eyepiece cap
(0 322) before taking pictures without your eye to the
viewfinder (0 80). To prevent loss of power before the exposure
is complete, use a fully charged battery. Note that noise (bright
spots, randomly-spaced bright pixels, or fog) may be present in
long exposures. Bright spots and fog can be reduced by
choosing On for Long exposure NR in the shooting menu
(0 230).

P, S, A, and M Modes 125

❚❚ Bulb

1 Rotate the mode dial to M.

Mode dial

2 Choose the shutter speed.
Rotate the command dial to choose a
shutter speed of Bulb (A).

Command dial

3 Take the photograph.
After focusing, press the shutter-release button on the
camera, optional wireless remote controller or remote cord
all the way down. Take your finger from the shutter-release
button when the exposure is complete.

126 P, S, A, and M Modes

❚❚ Time

1 Rotate the mode dial to M.

Mode dial

2 Choose the shutter speed.
Rotate the command dial left to
choose a shutter speed of “Time” (&).

Command dial

3 Open the shutter.
After focusing, press the shutter-release button on the
camera or a remote cord or wireless remote controller all the
way down.

4 Close the shutter.
Repeat the operation performed in Step 3.

P, S, A, and M Modes 127

Exposure
Metering
Choose how the camera sets exposure.
Method

Description
Produces natural results in most situations. The
camera meters a wide area of the frame and sets
L Matrix metering
exposure according to tone distribution, color,
composition, and distance.
Classic meter for portraits. Camera meters entire
Center-weighted frame but assigns greatest weight to center area.
M
Recommended when using filters with an
metering
exposure factor (filter factor) over 1×.
Choose this mode to ensure that subject will be
correctly exposed, even when background is
N Spot metering
much brighter or darker. Camera meters current
focus point; use to meter off-center subjects.

1 Display metering options.
Press the P button, then highlight the
current metering method in the
information display and press J.
P button

Information display

128 P, S, A, and M Modes

2 Choose a metering method.
Highlight an option and press J.

A Spot Metering
If e (Auto-area AF) is selected for AF-area mode during viewfinder
photography (0 87), the camera will meter the center focus point.

P, S, A, and M Modes 129

Autoexposure Lock
Use autoexposure lock to recompose photographs after using
M (Center-weighted metering) and N (Spot metering) to
meter exposure; note that autoexposure lock is not available in
i or j mode.

1 Lock exposure.
Position the subject in the selected
focus point and press the shutterrelease button halfway. With the
shutter-release button pressed
halfway and the subject positioned in
the focus point, press the A (L)
button to lock exposure.

Shutter-release
button

A (L) button

While exposure lock is in effect, an AE-L
indicator will appear in the viewfinder
and the monitor.

2 Recompose the
photograph.
Keeping the A (L) button
pressed, recompose the
photograph and shoot.

130 P, S, A, and M Modes

A Adjusting Shutter Speed and Aperture
While exposure lock is in effect, the following settings can be adjusted
without altering the metered value for exposure:
Mode
Programmed auto
Shutter-priority auto
Aperture-priority auto

Setting
Shutter speed and aperture
(flexible program; 0 120)
Shutter speed
Aperture

The metering method itself can not be changed while exposure lock is
in effect.

P, S, A, and M Modes 131

Exposure Compensation
Exposure compensation is used to alter exposure from the value
suggested by the camera, making pictures brighter or darker
(0 358). In general, positive values make the subject brighter
while negative values make it darker. It is most effective when
used with M (Center-weighted metering) or N (Spot
metering) (0 128).

–1 EV

No exposure
compensation

+1 EV

To choose a value for exposure compensation, keep the E (N)
button pressed and rotate the command dial until the desired
value is selected in the viewfinder or information display.

+
E (N) button

–0.3 EV

132 P, S, A, and M Modes

Command dial

Information display

+2 EV

Normal exposure can be restored by setting exposure
compensation to ±0. Except in h and % modes, exposure
compensation is not reset when the camera is turned off (in
h and % modes, exposure compensation will be reset when
another mode is selected or the camera is turned off ).

A The Information Display
Exposure compensation options can also be
accessed from the information display
(0 12).

A Mode M
In mode M, exposure compensation affects only the exposure
indicator.

A Using a Flash
When a flash is used, exposure compensation affects both background
exposure and flash level.

A Bracketing
For information on automatically varying exposure over a series of
shots, see page 151.

P, S, A, and M Modes 133

Flash Compensation
Flash compensation is used to alter flash output from the level
suggested by the camera, changing the brightness of the main
subject relative to the background. Flash output can be
increased to make the main subject appear brighter, or reduced
to prevent unwanted highlights or reflections (0 360).
Keep the M (Y) and E (N) buttons pressed and rotate the
command dial until the desired value is selected in the
viewfinder or information display. In general, positive values
make the main subject seem brighter while negative values
make it seem darker. Normal flash output can be restored by
setting flash compensation to ±0. Except in h mode, flash
compensation is not reset when the camera is turned off (in
h mode, flash compensation will be reset when another
mode is selected or the camera is turned off ).
M (Y) button

+
Command dial

Information display

E (N) button

–0.3 EV

134 P, S, A, and M Modes

+1 EV

A The Information Display
Flash compensation options can also be
accessed from the information display
(0 12).

A Optional Flash Units
Flash compensation is also available with optional flash units that
support the Nikon Creative Lighting System (CLS; see page 315). The
flash compensation selected with the optional flash unit is added to
the flash compensation selected with the camera.

P, S, A, and M Modes 135

Preserving Detail in Highlights and
Shadows
Active D-Lighting
Active D-Lighting preserves details in highlights and shadows,
creating photographs with natural contrast. Use for high
contrast scenes, for example when photographing brightly lit
outdoor scenery through a door or window or taking pictures of
shaded subjects on a sunny day. Active D-Lighting is not
recommended in mode M; in other modes, it is most effective
when used with L (Matrix metering; 0 128).

Active D-Lighting: ! Off

Active D-Lighting: Y Auto

1 Display Active D-Lighting options.
Press the P button, then highlight
Active D-Lighting in the information
display and press J.
P button

Information display

136 P, S, A, and M Modes

2 Choose an option.
Highlight an option and press J
(0 359).

D Active D-Lighting
With some subjects, you may notice uneven shading, shadows around
bright objects, or halos around dark objects. Active D-Lighting is not
available with movies.

A “Active D-Lighting” Versus “D-Lighting”
Active D-Lighting adjusts exposure before shooting to optimize the
dynamic range, while the D-Lighting option in the retouch menu
(0 285) brightens shadows in images after shooting.
A Bracketing
For information on automatically varying Active D-Lighting over a
series of shots, see page 151.

P, S, A, and M Modes 137

High Dynamic Range (HDR)
High Dynamic Range (HDR) combines two exposures to form a
single image that captures a wide range of tones from shadows
to highlights, even with high-contrast subjects. HDR is most
effective when used with L (Matrix metering) (0 128). It can
not be used to record NEF (RAW) images. While HDR is in effect,
the flash can not be used and continuous shooting is not
available.

+
First exposure (darker)

Second exposure
(brighter)

Combined HDR image

1 Display HDR (high dynamic range)
options.
Press the P button, then highlight
HDR (high dynamic range) in the
information display and press J.
P button

Information display

138 P, S, A, and M Modes

2 Choose an option.
Highlight v Auto, 2 Extra high,
S High, T Normal, U Low, or
6 Off and press J.
When an option other than 6 Off is
selected, u will be displayed in the
viewfinder.

3 Frame a photograph, focus, and shoot.
The camera takes two exposures
when the shutter-release button is
pressed all the way down. “l u”
will flash in the viewfinder while the images are combined; no
photographs can be taken until recording is complete. HDR
turns off automatically after the photograph is taken; to turn
off HDR before shooting, rotate the mode dial to a setting
other than P, S, A, or M.

D Framing HDR Photographs
The edges of the image may be cropped out. The desired results may
not be achieved if the camera or subject moves during shooting. Use
of a tripod is recommended. Depending on the scene, the effect may
not be visible, shadows may appear around bright objects, or halos
may appear around dark objects. Uneven shading may be visible with
some subjects.

P, S, A, and M Modes 139

White Balance
White balance ensures that colors are unaffected by the color of
the light source. Auto white balance is recommended for most
light sources; other values can be selected if necessary
according to the type of source:
Option
v Auto
J
I
H
N
G
M

Incandescent
Fluorescent
Direct sunlight
Flash
Cloudy
Shade

L Preset manual

Description
Automatic white balance adjustment.
Recommended in most situations.
Use under incandescent lighting.
Use with the light sources listed on page 141.
Use with subjects lit by direct sunlight.
Use with the flash.
Use in daylight under overcast skies.
Use in daylight with subjects in the shade.
Measure white balance or copy white balance
from existing photo (0 145).

1 Display white balance options.
Press the P button, then highlight the
current white balance setting in the
information display and press J.
P button

Information display

140 P, S, A, and M Modes

2 Choose a white balance option.
Highlight an option and press J.

A The Shooting Menu
White balance can be selected using the
White balance option in the shooting menu
(0 223), which also can be used to fine-tune
white balance (0 143) or measure a value
for preset white balance (0 145).
The I Fluorescent option in the White
balance menu can be used to select the
light source from the bulb types shown at
right.

A Touch Menu Navigation
Tap an option in the white balance menu once to highlight it and again
to select it and either display a menu of bulb types (I Fluorescent) or
return to the shooting menu.

P, S, A, and M Modes 141

A Color Temperature
The perceived color of a light source varies with the viewer and other
conditions. Color temperature is an objective measure of the color of a
light source, defined with reference to the temperature to which an
object would have to be heated to radiate light in the same
wavelengths. While light sources with a color temperature in the
neighborhood of 5000–5500 K appear white, light sources with a lower
color temperature, such as incandescent light bulbs, appear slightly
yellow or red. Light sources with a higher color temperature appear
tinged with blue.
“Warmer” (redder) colors
3000

q

w

4000

e

r

“Cooler” (bluer) colors
5000

6000

tyu i

8000

o

!0

10000

[K]

!1

q I (sodium-vapor lamps): 2700 K
w J (incandescent)/I (warm-white fluorescent.): 3000 K
e I (white fluorescent): 3700 K
r I (cool-white fluorescent): 4200 K
t I (day white fluorescent): 5000 K
y H (direct sunlight): 5200 K
u N (flash): 5400 K
i G (cloudy): 6000 K
o I (daylight fluorescent): 6500 K
!0 I (high temp. mercury-vapor): 7200 K
!1 M (shade): 8000 K
Note: All figures are approximate.

A Bracketing
For information on automatically varying white balance settings over a
series of shots, see page 151.

142 P, S, A, and M Modes

Fine-Tuning White Balance
White balance can be “fine-tuned” to compensate for variations
in the color of the light source or to introduce a deliberate color
cast into an image. White balance is fine-tuned using the White
balance option in the shooting menu.

1 Display fine-tuning options.
Highlight a white balance option and
press 2 (if Fluorescent is selected,
highlight the desired lighting type
and press 2; note that fine-tuning is
not available with Preset manual).

2 Fine-tune white balance.

Coordinates

Use the multi selector to fine-tune
white balance. White balance can be
fine-tuned on the amber (A)–blue (B)
axis in steps of 0.5 and the green (G)–
magenta (M) axis in steps of 0.25. The
horizontal (amber-blue) axis
Adjustment
corresponds to color temperature,
while the vertical (green-magenta)
axis has the similar effects to the corresponding color
compensation (CC) filters. The horizontal axis is ruled in
increments equivalent to about 5 mired, the vertical axis in
increments of about 0.05 diffuse density units.

3 Save changes and exit.
Press J.

P, S, A, and M Modes 143

A White Balance Fine-Tuning
The colors on the fine-tuning axes are relative, not absolute. For
example, moving the cursor to B (blue) when a “warm” setting such as
J (incandescent) is selected will make photographs slightly “colder”
but will not actually make them blue.

A Touch Fine-Tuning
To fine-tune an option in the white balance menu using the touch
screen, tap the option once to highlight it and then tap the 2 Adjust
button to view the fine-tuning display. To choose a value, tap the
coordinate display or the u, v, x, or y icons. Tap 0 OK to return to the
shooting menu once white balance has been adjusted to your
satisfaction.

A “Mired”
Any given change in color temperature produces a greater difference
in color at low color temperatures than it would at higher color
temperatures. For example, a change of 1000 K produces a much
greater change in color at 3000 K than at 6000 K. Mired, calculated by
multiplying the inverse of the color temperature by 10 6, is a measure of
color temperature that takes such variation into account, and as such is
the unit used in color-temperature compensation filters. E.g.:
• 4000 K–3000 K (a difference of 1000 K)=83 mired
• 7000 K–6000 K (a difference of 1000 K)=24 mired

144 P, S, A, and M Modes

Preset Manual
Preset manual is used to record and recall custom white balance
settings for shooting under mixed lighting or to compensate for
light sources with a strong color cast. Two methods are available
for setting preset white balance:
Method
Measure
Use photo

Description
Neutral gray or white object is placed under lighting that
will be used in final photo and white balance measured by
camera (see below).
White balance is copied from photo on memory card
(0 149).

❚❚ Measuring a Value for Preset White Balance

1 Light a reference object.
Place a neutral gray or white object under the lighting that
will be used in the final photograph.

2 Display white balance options.
Highlight White balance in the
shooting menu and press 2 to display
white balance options. Highlight
Preset manual and press 2.

3 Select Measure.
Highlight Measure and press 2.

P, S, A, and M Modes 145

4 Select Yes.
The menu shown at right will be
displayed; highlight Yes and press J.

The camera will enter preset
measurement mode.

When the camera is ready to measure
white balance, a flashing D (L) will
appear in the viewfinder and
information display.

5 Measure white balance.
Before the indicators stop flashing,
frame the reference object so that it
fills the viewfinder and press the
shutter-release button all the way down. No photograph will
be recorded; white balance can be measured accurately even
when the camera is not in focus.

146 P, S, A, and M Modes

6 Check the results.
If the camera was able to measure a
value for white balance, the message
shown at right will be displayed and
a will flash in the viewfinder and the
camera will return to shooting mode.
To return to shooting mode
immediately, press the shutter-release
button halfway.
If lighting is too dark or too bright, the
camera may be unable to measure
white balance. A message will appear
in the information display and a
flashing b a will appear in the
viewfinder. Return to Step 5 and
measure white balance again.

P, S, A, and M Modes 147

D Measuring Preset White Balance
If no operations are performed while the displays are flashing, direct
measurement mode will end in the time selected for Custom Setting
c2 (Auto off timers; 0 240).

D Preset White Balance
The camera can store only one value for preset white balance at a time;
the existing value will be replaced when a new value is measured.
Note that exposure is automatically increased by 1 EV when measuring
white balance; when shooting in mode M, adjust exposure so that the
exposure indicator shows ±0 (0 124).

A Other Methods for Measuring Preset White Balance
To enter preset measurement mode (see above) after selecting preset
white balance in the information display (0 140), press J for a few
seconds. If white balance has been assigned to the Fn button (0 252),
white balance preset measurement mode can be activated by keeping
the Fn button pressed for a few seconds after selecting preset white
balance with the Fn button and command dial.

A Gray Panels
For more precise results, measure white balance using a standard gray
panel.

148 P, S, A, and M Modes

❚❚ Copying White Balance from a Photograph
Follow the steps below to copy a value for white balance from a
photograph on the memory card.

1 Select Preset manual.
Highlight White balance in the
shooting menu and press 2 to display
white balance options. Highlight
Preset manual and press 2.

2 Select Use photo.
Highlight Use photo and press 2.

3 Choose Select image.
Highlight Select image and press 2
(to skip the remaining steps and use
the image last selected for preset
white balance, select This image).

4 Choose a folder.
Highlight the folder containing the
source image and press 2.

P, S, A, and M Modes 149

5 Highlight the source image.
To view the highlighted image full
frame, press and hold the X button.

6 Copy white balance.
Press J to set preset white balance to the white balance
value for the highlighted photograph.

150 P, S, A, and M Modes

Bracketing
Bracketing automatically varies exposure, white balance, or
Active D-Lighting (ADL) settings slightly with each shot,
“bracketing” the current value. Choose in situations in which it is
difficult to set exposure or white balance and there is not time to
check results and adjust settings with each shot, or to
experiment with different settings for the same subject.
Option

Description
Vary exposure over a series of three photographs.

k AE bracketing
Shot 1:
Shot 2: exposure Shot 3: exposure
unmodified
reduced
increased
Each time the shutter is released, the camera creates
m WB bracketing three images, each with a different white balance.
Not available with image qualities of NEF (RAW).
Take one photo with Active D-Lighting off, and
! ADL bracketing
another at the current Active D-Lighting setting.

1 Choose a bracketing option.
Highlight e2 (Auto bracketing set) in
the Custom Settings menu and press
2.
Highlight the desired bracketing type
and press J.

P, S, A, and M Modes 151

2 Display bracketing options.
Press the P button, then highlight the
current bracketing setting and press
J.
P button

Information display

3 Select a bracketing increment.
Highlight a bracketing increment and
press J. Choose from values between
0.3 and 2 EV (AE bracketing) or 1 to 3
(WB bracketing), or select ADL (ADL
bracketing).

152 P, S, A, and M Modes

4 Frame a photograph, focus, and
shoot.
AE bracketing: The camera will vary
exposure with each shot. The first
shot will be taken at the value currently selected for exposure
compensation. The bracketing increment will be subtracted
from the current value in the second shot and added in the
third shot, “bracketing” the current value. The modified
values are reflected in the values shown for shutter speed and
aperture.
WB bracketing: Each shot is processed to create three copies,
one at the current white balance setting, one with increased
amber, and one with increased blue.
ADL bracketing: The first shot after bracketing is activated is
taken with Active D-Lighting off, the second at the current
Active D-Lighting setting (0 136; if Active D-Lighting is off,
the second shot will be taken with Active D-Lighting set to
Auto).
In continuous high-speed and continuous low-speed release
modes, shooting will pause after each bracketing cycle. If the
camera is turned off before all shots in the bracketing sequence
have been taken, bracketing will resume from the next shot in
the sequence when the camera is turned on.

P, S, A, and M Modes 153

A The Bracketing Progress Indicator
During AE bracketing, a bar is removed
from the bracketing progress indicator
with each shot (v > w > x).

During ADL bracketing, the setting that
will be used for the next shot is underlined
in the information display.

A Disabling Bracketing
To disable bracketing and resume normal shooting, select OFF in
Step 3 (0 152). Bracketing can also be cancelled by performing a twobutton reset (0 115). To cancel bracketing before all frames have been
recorded, rotate the mode dial to a setting other than P, S, A, or M.

A Exposure Bracketing
The camera modifies exposure by varying shutter speed and aperture
(mode P), aperture (mode S), or shutter speed (modes A and M). If auto
ISO sensitivity control is enabled, the camera will automatically vary
ISO sensitivity for optimum exposure when the limits of the camera
exposure system are exceeded.

154 P, S, A, and M Modes

Picture Controls
Picture Controls are preset combinations of image processing
settings that include sharpening, clarity, contrast, brightness,
saturation, and hue. You can select a Picture Control to match
the scene or customize settings to suit your creative intent.

Selecting a Picture Control
Choose a Picture Control according to the subject or type of
scene.
Option
Q Standard
R Neutral

S Vivid
T Monochrome
e Portrait
f Landscape
q Flat

Description
Recommended for most situations, this option uses
standard processing for balanced results.
A good choice for photographs that will later be
processed or retouched, this option uses minimal
processing for natural results.
Choose this option for photographs that emphasize
primary colors. Pictures are enhanced for a vivid,
photoprint effect.
Take monochrome photographs.
Process portraits for skin with natural texture and a
rounded feel.
Produces vibrant landscapes and cityscapes.
Choose for photographs that will later be
extensively processed or retouched. Details are
preserved over a wide tone range, from highlights
to shadows.

P, S, A, and M Modes 155

1 Display Picture Control options.
Press the P button, then highlight the
current Picture Control and press J.

P button

Information display

2 Select a Picture Control.
Highlight a Picture Control and press
J.

A Touch Menu Navigation
Picture Controls can also be selected in the shooting menu (0 223).
When choosing an option from the Set Picture Control menu using
the touch screen (0 25), tap the option once to highlight it and again
to select it.

156 P, S, A, and M Modes

Modifying Picture Controls
Existing preset or custom Picture Controls (0 161) can be
modified to suit the scene or the user’s creative intent. Choose a
balanced combination of settings using Quick adjust, or make
manual adjustments to individual settings.

1 Select a Picture Control.
Highlight Set Picture Control in the
shooting menu and press 2.
Highlight the desired Picture Control
and press 2.

2 Adjust settings.
Press 1 or 3 to highlight the desired
setting and press 4 or 2 to choose a
value in increments of 1, or rotate the
command dial to choose a value in
increments of 0.25 (0 158). Repeat
this step until all settings have been adjusted, or select a
preset combination of settings by using the multi selector to
choose Quick adjust. Default settings can be restored by
pressing the O button.

3 Save changes and exit.
Press J.
Picture Controls that have been
modified from default settings are
indicated by an asterisk (“*”).

P, S, A, and M Modes 157

❚❚ Picture Control Settings
Option

Quick adjust

Sharpening
Manual adjustments
(all Picture Controls)

Clarity

Contrast
Brightness

Description
Mute or heighten the effect of the selected
Picture Control (note that this resets all manual
adjustments). Not available with Neutral,
Monochrome, Flat, or custom Picture Controls
(0 161).
Control the sharpness of outlines. Select A to
adjust sharpening automatically according to
the type of scene.
Adjust clarity manually or select A to let the
camera adjust clarity automatically.
Depending on the scene, shadows may appear
around bright objects or halos may appear
around dark objects at some settings. Clarity is
not applied to movies.
Adjust contrast manually or select A to let the
camera adjust contrast automatically.
Raise or lower brightness without loss of detail
in highlights or shadows.

Manual adjustments
(non-monochrome only)
Manual adjustments
(monochrome only)

Saturation

Control the vividness of colors. Select A to
adjust saturation automatically according to
the type of scene.

Hue

Adjust hue.

Filter effects

Simulate the effect of color filters on
monochrome photographs (0 160).

Toning

Choose the tint used in monochrome
photographs (0 160).

158 P, S, A, and M Modes

D “A” (Auto)
Results for auto sharpening, clarity, contrast, and saturation vary with
exposure and the position of the subject in the frame.

A Switching Between Manual and Auto
Press the X button to switch back and forth
between manual and auto (A) settings for
sharpening, clarity, contrast, and saturation.

A Custom Picture Controls
Custom Picture Controls are created through modifications to existing
Picture Controls using the Manage Picture Control option in the
shooting menu (0 161) and can be saved to a memory card for sharing
among other cameras of the same model and compatible software
(0 163).

A Previous Settings
The j indicator under the value display in
the Picture Control setting menu indicates
the previous value for the setting. Use this as
a reference when adjusting settings.

A Custom Picture Control Options
The options available with custom Picture Controls are the same as
those on which the custom Picture Control was based.

A Using the Touch Screen
To use the touch screen to modify a Picture
Control in the Set Picture Control menu,
tap the Picture Control once to highlight it
and then tap the 2 Adjust button to view
the menu shown in Step 2 on page 157. Tap
a parameter once to highlight it and again to
display options, then use the on-screen
controls to choose a value (the multi selector can not be used). Note
that the touch screen can only be used for this purpose if Enable is
selected for Touch controls.

P, S, A, and M Modes 159

A Filter Effects (Monochrome Only)
The options in this menu simulate the effect of color filters on
monochrome photographs. The following filter effects are available:
Y

Option
Yellow

O

Orange

R

Red

G

Green

Description
Enhances contrast. Can be used to tone down the
brightness of the sky in landscape photographs.
Orange produces more contrast than yellow, red
more contrast than orange.
Softens skin tones. Can be used for portraits.

A Toning (Monochrome Only)
Pressing 3 when Toning is selected displays
saturation options. Press 4 or 2 to adjust
saturation in increments of 1, or rotate the
command dial to choose a value in
increments of 0.25. Saturation control is not
available when B&W (black-and-white) is
selected.

A Touch-Screen Character Entry
To type, tap the letters in the keyboard area (you can select letters by
sliding a finger over the screen: the letters are highlighted as you touch
them and are not entered in the text area until you lift your finger). To
position the cursor, tap directly in the text area or tap the x or y
buttons.

160 P, S, A, and M Modes

Creating Custom Picture Controls
The Picture Controls supplied with the camera can be modified
and saved as custom Picture Controls.

1 Select Manage Picture Control.
Highlight Manage Picture Control in
the shooting menu and press 2.

2 Select Save/edit.
Highlight Save/edit and press 2.

3 Select a Picture Control.
Highlight an existing Picture Control
and press 2, or press J to proceed to
Step 5 to save a copy of the
highlighted Picture Control without
further modification.

4 Edit the selected Picture Control.
See page 158 for more information.
To abandon any changes and start
over from default settings, press the O
button. Press J when settings are
complete.

P, S, A, and M Modes 161

5 Select a destination.
Highlight a destination for the custom
Picture Control (C-1 through C-9) and
press 2.

6 Name the Picture Control.

Name area

By default, new Picture Controls are
named by adding a two-digit number
(assigned automatically) to the name
of the existing Picture Control; to use
the default name, proceed to Step 7.
To move the cursor in the name area,
Keyboard area
rotate the command dial. To enter a
new letter at the current cursor
position, use the multi selector to highlight the desired
character in the keyboard area and press J. To delete the
character at the current cursor position, press the O button.
Custom Picture Control names can be up to nineteen
characters long. Any characters after the nineteenth will be
deleted.

7 Press X.
Press X to save changes and exit. The
new Picture Control will appear in the
Picture Control list.

162 P, S, A, and M Modes

A Manage Picture Control > Rename
Custom Picture Controls can be renamed at any time using the
Rename option in the Manage Picture Control menu.

A Manage Picture Control > Delete
The Delete option in the Manage Picture Control menu can be used
to delete selected custom Picture Controls when they are no longer
needed.

A The Original Picture Control Icon
The original preset Picture Control on which
the custom Picture Control is based is
indicated by an icon in the top right corner
of the edit display.

Original
Picture Control icon

A Sharing Custom Picture Controls
The Load/save item in the Manage Picture
Control menu offers the options listed
below. Use these options to copy custom
Picture Controls to and from memory cards.
Once copied to memory cards, Picture
Controls can be used with other cameras or
compatible software.
• Copy to camera: Copy custom Picture Controls from the memory card to
custom Picture Controls C-1 through C-9 on the camera and name
them as desired.
• Delete from card: Delete selected custom Picture Controls from the
memory card.
• Copy to card: Copy a custom Picture Control (C-1 through C-9) from the
camera to a selected destination (1 through 99) on the memory card.

P, S, A, and M Modes 163

Recording and Viewing Movies
Recording Movies
Movies can be recorded in live view mode.

1 Rotate the live view switch.
The view through the lens will be
displayed in the monitor.
D The 0 Icon
A 0 icon (0 11) indicates that movies
can not be recorded.
A Before Recording
If you are using a type E or PC-E NIKKOR
lens (0 305, 307), you can choose the
aperture for exposure modes A and M
during live view (0 122, 123).

2 Focus.
Frame the opening shot and focus.
Note that the number of subjects that
can be detected in face-priority AF
drops during movie recording.

164 Recording and Viewing Movies

Live view switch

3 Start recording.
Press the movie-record button to start
recording. A recording indicator and
the time available are displayed in the
monitor. Sound is recorded via the
built-in microphone (0 2); be careful
Movie-record button
not to obstruct the microphone
during recording. Except in i and j
Time remaining
modes, exposure can be locked by
pressing the A (L) button (0 130)
or (in h, P, S, A, and % modes)
altered by up to ±3 EV in steps of 1/3 EV
by pressing the E (N) button and
rotating the command dial (0 132;
note that depending on the
Recording indicator
brightness of the subject, changes to
exposure may have no visible effect).

4 End recording.
Press the movie-record button again to end recording.
Recording will end automatically when the maximum length
is reached, the memory card is full, another mode is selected,
or the monitor is closed (closing the monitor does not end
recording on televisions or other external displays).

5 End live view.
Rotate the live view switch to end live view.

Recording and Viewing Movies 165

The P Button
When movie indicators are displayed by
pressing the R button in live view mode,
the following settings can be accessed by
pressing the P button:
• Movie frame size/quality (0 168)
• Microphone (0 169)
P button
• White balance (0 140)
• Exposure compensation (0 132) *
• Picture Control (0 155)
• Wind noise reduction (0 169)
• Focus mode (0 82)
• AF-area mode (0 87)
* ISO sensitivity will be displayed in place of
exposure compensation if On is selected for Movie settings > Manual
movie settings (0 169) in mode M.

A Taking Photographs During Movie Recording
To end movie recording, take a photograph, and exit to live view, press
the shutter-release button all the way down and hold it in this position
until the shutter is released. The touch shutter (0 19) can not be used
to take photos during movie recording.

A Maximum Length
The maximum length for individual movie files is 4 GB (for maximum
recording times, see page 168); note that depending on memory card
write speed, shooting may end before this length is reached (0 324).

166 Recording and Viewing Movies

D Recording Movies
Flicker, banding, or distortion may be visible in the monitor and in the
final movie under fluorescent, mercury vapor, or sodium lamps or with
subjects that are in motion, particularly if the camera is panned
horizontally or an object moves horizontally at high speed through
frame (for information on reducing flicker and banding, see Flicker
reduction; 0 268). Jagged edges, color fringing, moire, and bright
spots may also appear. Bright regions or bands may appear in some
areas of the frame with flashing signs and other intermittent light
sources or if the subject is briefly illuminated by a strobe or other
bright, momentary light source. Avoid pointing the camera at the sun
or other strong light sources. Failure to observe this precaution could
result in damage to the camera’s internal circuitry.
The camera can record both video and sound; do not cover the
microphone during recording. Note that the built-in microphone may
record lens noise during autofocus and vibration reduction.
Flash lighting can not be used during movie recording.
Matrix metering is used regardless of the metering method selected.
Shutter speed and ISO sensitivity are adjusted automatically unless On
is selected for Manual movie settings (0 169) and the camera is in
mode M.

Recording and Viewing Movies 167

Movie Settings
Use the Movie settings option in the shooting menu (0 170) to
adjust the following settings.
• Frame size/frame rate and Movie quality: The maximum
length varies with the options selected.
Movie quality

Frame size/frame rate 1
Maximum length 2
L 1920×1080; 60p
10 min.
M 1920×1080; 50p
N 1920×1080; 30p
High quality
O 1920×1080; 25p
P 1920×1080; 24p
20 min.
Q 1280× 720; 60p
R 1280× 720; 50p
t 1920×1080; 60p
20 min.
u 1920×1080; 50p
r 1920×1080; 30p
s 1920×1080; 25p
Normal
k 1920×1080; 24p
29 min. 59 s
l 1280× 720; 60p
o 1280× 720; 50p
1 Listed value. Actual frame rates for 60p, 50p, 30p, 25p, and 24p are 59.94, 50, 29.97, 25, and
23.976 fps respectively.
2 Movies recorded in miniature effect mode are up to three minutes long when played back.

168 Recording and Viewing Movies

• Microphone: Turn the built-in or optional stereo
microphones (0 170, 323) on or off or adjust microphone
sensitivity. Choose Auto sensitivity to adjust sensitivity
automatically, Microphone off to turn sound recording off; to
select microphone sensitivity manually, select Manual
sensitivity and choose a sensitivity.
• Wind noise reduction: Select On to enable the low-cut filter
for the built-in microphone (optional stereo microphones are
unaffected; 0 170, 323), reducing noise produced by wind
blowing over the microphone (note that other sounds may
also be affected). Wind-noise reduction for optional stereo
microphones can be enabled or disabled using microphone
controls.
• Manual movie settings: Choose On to allow manual
adjustments to shutter speed and ISO sensitivity when the
camera is in mode M. Shutter speed can be set to values as
fast as 1/4000 s; the slowest speed available varies with the
frame rate: 1/30 s for frame rates of 24p, 25p, and 30p, 1/50 s for
50p, and 1/60 s for 60p. If shutter speed is not in this range
when live view starts, it will automatically be set to a
supported value, and remain at this value when live view
ends. Note that ISO sensitivity is fixed at the value selected;
the camera does not adjust ISO sensitivity automatically
when On is selected for ISO sensitivity settings > Auto ISO
sensitivity control in the shooting menu (0 228).

Recording and Viewing Movies 169

1 Select Movie settings.
Highlight Movie settings in the
shooting menu and press 2.

2 Choose movie options.
Highlight the desired item and press
2, then highlight an option and press
J.

A Using an External Microphone
Optional stereo microphones can be used to reduce noise caused by
lens vibration being recorded during autofocus.

A HDMI
When the camera is attached to an HDMI video device, the video
device will display the view through the lens. If the device supports
HDMI-CEC, select Off for the HDMI > Device control option in the
setup menu (0 219) before shooting in live view.

170 Recording and Viewing Movies

Time-Lapse Movies
The camera automatically takes photos at selected intervals to
create a silent time-lapse movie using the options currently
selected for Frame size/frame rate and Movie quality under
Movie settings in the shooting menu (0 168).
A Before Shooting
Time-lapse movies are shot using the movie crop; before shooting a
time-lapse movie, take a test shot at current settings and view the
results in the monitor. For consistent coloration, choose a white
balance setting other than auto (0 140).
Use of a tripod is recommended. Mount the camera on a tripod before
shooting begins. To ensure that shooting is not interrupted, use an
optional AC adapter and power connector or a fully-charged battery.
To prevent light entering via the viewfinder interfering with
photographs and exposure, cover the viewfinder with your hand or
other object or attach the optional viewfinder eyepiece cap (0 80).

1 Select Time-lapse movie.
Highlight Time-lapse movie in the
shooting menu and press 2 to display
time-lapse movie settings.

Recording and Viewing Movies 171

2 Adjust time-lapse movie settings.
Choose an interval, total shooting time, and exposure
smoothing option.
• To choose the interval between frames:

Highlight Interval and
press 2.

Choose an interval longer than
the slowest anticipated shutter
speed (minutes and seconds)
and press J.

• To choose the total shooting time:

Highlight Shooting time and
press 2.

172 Recording and Viewing Movies

Choose shooting time (up to
7 hours 59 minutes) and
press J.

• To enable or disable exposure smoothing:

Highlight Exposure smoothing
and press 2.

Highlight an option and
press J.

Selecting On smooths abrupt changes in exposure in
modes other than M (note that exposure smoothing only
takes effect in mode M if auto ISO sensitivity control is
enabled in the shooting menu).

3 Start shooting.
Highlight Start and press J.
Shooting starts after about 3 s. The
camera takes photographs at the
selected interval for the selected
shooting time. When complete, timelapse movies are recorded to the memory card.

A Calculating the Length of the Final Movie
The total number of frames in the final
movie can be calculated by dividing the
shooting time by the interval and rounding
up. The length of the final movie can then
be calculated by dividing the number of
shots by the frame rate selected for Frame
size/frame rate in the shooting menu
(0 168). A 48 frame movie recorded at
1920 × 1080; 24p, for example, will be
about two seconds long. The maximum
length for time-lapse movies is 20 minutes.

Length recorded/
maximum length

Memory card
indicator
Frame size/frame rate

Recording and Viewing Movies 173

❚❚ Ending Shooting
To end shooting before all the photos are taken, press J
between frames or immediately after a frame is recorded. A
movie will be created from the frames shot to the point where
shooting ended. Note that if the power source is removed or
disconnected or the destination memory card is ejected, no
movie will be recorded and shooting will end without a beep
being sounded.

❚❚ No Photograph
The camera will skip the current frame if it is unable to focus for
eight seconds or more in AF-S or when single-servo AF is selected
in AF-A or Focus is selected for Custom Setting a1 (AF-C priority
selection) in AF-C (note that the camera focuses again before
each shot). Shooting will resume with the next frame.

D Time-Lapse Movies
Time-lapse is not available in special effects mode (0 65), during live
view (0 9, 47) or movie recording (0 164), at a shutter speed of A
or & (0 125), or when the self-timer (0 79), bracketing (0 151), High
Dynamic Range (HDR, 0 138), or interval timer photography (0 109)
is active. Note that because shutter speed and the time needed to
record the image to the memory card may vary from shot to shot, the
interval between a shot being recorded and the start of the next shot
may vary. Shooting will not begin if a time-lapse movie can not be
recorded at current settings (for example, if the memory card is full, the
interval or shooting time is zero, or the interval is longer than the
shooting time).
Shooting may end if camera controls are used or settings are changed
or HDMI cable is connected. A movie will be created from the frames
shot to the point where shooting ended.

174 Recording and Viewing Movies

A During Shooting
The memory card access lamp lights while
shooting is in progress. A message will
appear in the information display if the R
button is pressed between shots. The
standby timer does not turn off, regardless
of the option selected for Custom Setting c2
(Auto off timers) > Standby timer.

A Image Review
The K button can not be used to view pictures while shooting is in
progress.

A Release Mode
Regardless of the release mode selected, the camera will take one shot
at each interval.

A Opening and Closing the Monitor
Returning the monitor to the storage position does not interrupt timelapse movie recording.

Recording and Viewing Movies 175

Viewing Movies
Movies are indicated by a 1 icon in full-frame playback (0 184).
Tap the a icon in the monitor or press J to start playback; your
current position is indicated by the movie progress bar.
1 icon

Current position/
total length

Length

Volume

1

a icon

Movie progress bar

Guide

The following operations can be performed:
To
Pause

Use

Description
Pause playback.

Play

Resume playback when movie is paused or
during rewind/advance.

Advance/
rewind

Speed increases with each press, from 2× to
4× to 8× to 16×; keep pressed to skip to
beginning or end of movie (first frame is
indicated by h in top right corner of
monitor, last frame by i). If playback is
paused, movie rewinds or advances one
frame at a time; hold for continuous rewind
or advance.

Skip 10 s

Rotate the command dial one stop to skip
ahead or back 10 s.

176 Recording and Viewing Movies

To
Adjust
volume
Return to
full-frame
playback

Use
X/W (Q)
K/

Description
Press X to increase volume, W (Q) to
decrease.
Press K or 1 to exit to full-frame playback.

Recording and Viewing Movies 177

Editing Movies
Trim footage to create edited copies of movies or save selected
frames as JPEG stills.
Option

Description
Create a copy from which unwanted
f Choose start/end point
footage has been removed.
g Save selected frame
Save a selected frame as a JPEG still.

Trimming Movies

To create trimmed copies of movies:

1 Display a movie full frame.
2 Pause the movie on the new
opening frame.
Play the movie back as described on
page 176, pressing J to start and
resume playback and 3 to pause and
pressing 4 or 2 or rotating the
Movie progress bar
command dial to locate the desired
frame. Your approximate position in
the movie can be ascertained from the movie progress bar.
Pause playback when you reach the new opening frame.

178 Recording and Viewing Movies

3 Select Choose start/end point.
Press the P button, then highlight
Choose start/end point and press 2.

P button

4 Select Start point.
To create a copy that begins from the
current frame, highlight Start point
and press J. The frames before the
current frame will be removed when
you save the copy in Step 9.

Start point

Recording and Viewing Movies 179

5 Confirm the new start point.
If the desired frame is not currently
displayed, press 4 or 2 to advance or
rewind (to skip to 10 s ahead or back,
rotate the command dial one stop).

6 Choose the end point.
Press A (L) to switch from the start point (w) to the end
point (x) selection tool and then select the closing frame as
described in Step 5. The frames after the selected frame will
be removed when you save the copy in Step 9.

End point

7 Create the copy.
Once the desired frame is displayed, press 1.

8 Preview the movie.
To preview the copy, highlight
Preview and press J (to interrupt the
preview and return to the save
options menu, press 1). To abandon
the current copy and select a new
start point or end point as described on the foregoing pages,
highlight Cancel and press J; to save the copy, proceed to
Step 9.

180 Recording and Viewing Movies

9 Save the copy.
Highlight Save as new file and press
J to save the copy to a new file. To
replace the original movie file with
the edited copy, highlight Overwrite
existing file and press J.

D Trimming Movies
Movies must be at least two seconds long. The copy will not be saved
if there is insufficient space available on the memory card.
Copies have the same time and date of creation as the original.

A Removing Opening or Closing Footage
To remove only the opening footage from the movie, proceed to Step
7 without pressing the A (L) button in Step 6. To remove only the
closing footage, select End point in Step 4, select the closing frame,
and proceed to Step 7 without pressing the A (L) button in Step 6.

Recording and Viewing Movies 181

Saving Selected Frames
To save a copy of a selected frame as a JPEG still:

1 Pause the movie on the desired
frame.
Play the movie back as described on
page 176, pressing J to start and
resume playback and 3 to pause.
Pause the movie at the frame you
intend to copy.

2 Choose Save selected frame.
Press the P button, then highlight
Save selected frame and press 2.

P button

3 Create a still copy.
Press 1 to create a still copy of the
current frame.

182 Recording and Viewing Movies

4 Save the copy.
Highlight Yes and press J to create a
fine-quality (0 98) JPEG copy of the
selected frame.

A Save Selected Frame
JPEG movie stills created with the Save selected frame option can not
be retouched. JPEG movie stills lack some categories of photo
information (0 188).

Recording and Viewing Movies 183

Playback and Deletion
Full-Frame Playback
To play photographs back, press the K button. The most recent
photograph will be displayed in the monitor.

K button
To

Use

View additional
photographs
View additional
photo info
Return to
shooting mode

Description
Press 2 to view photographs in
order recorded, 4 to view
photographs in reverse order.
Change photo info displayed
(0 188).

K/

Play movie

184 Playback and Deletion

Press the K button or press the
shutter-release button halfway to
exit to shooting mode.
If current picture is marked with 1
icon to show that it is a movie,
pressing J starts movie playback
(0 176).

Thumbnail Playback
To display images in “contact sheets” of 4, 12, or 80 images, press
the W (Q) button.
W (Q)

W (Q)

X
Full-frame
playback

X
Thumbnail playback

To

Use

Calendar
playback
Description

Highlight images

Use multi selector or command dial
to highlight pictures.

View highlighted
image

Press J to display the highlighted
image full frame.

Return to
shooting mode

K/

Press the K button or press the
shutter-release button halfway to
exit to shooting mode.

Playback and Deletion 185

Calendar Playback
To view images taken on a selected date, press the W (Q) button
when 80 images are displayed.
Date list
W (Q)

W (Q)

X

X
Thumbnail list

Full-frame
playback

Thumbnail
playback

Calendar
playback

The operations that can be performed depend on whether the
cursor is in the date list or the thumbnail list:
To

Use
W (Q)

Toggle between
date list and
thumbnail list
Exit to thumbnail
playback/Zoom
in on highlighted
photo

X

Description
Press W (Q) or J button in date list
to place cursor in thumbnail list.
Press W (Q) again to return to date
list.
• Date list: Exit to 80-frame playback.
• Thumbnail list: Press and hold X
button to zoom in on highlighted
picture.

Highlight dates/
Highlight images

• Date list: Highlight date.
• Thumbnail list: Highlight picture.

Toggle full frame
playback

• Thumbnail list: View highlighted
picture.

Return to
shooting mode

K/

186 Playback and Deletion

Press the K button or press the
shutter-release button halfway to
exit to shooting mode.

The P Button
Pressing the P button in full-frame,
thumbnail, or calendar playback displays
the options listed below. Highlight items
and press 2 to view options.
• Rating: Rate the current picture
(0 201).
P button
• Retouch (photographs only): Use the
options in the retouch menu (0 277)
to create a retouched copy of the
current photograph.
• Edit movie (movies only): Edit movies
using the options in the edit movie
menu (0 178). Movies can also be
edited by pressing the P button when movie playback is
paused.
• Select to send to smart device/deselect (photographs only): Select
photos for upload to a smart device.
To exit the P-button menu and return to playback, press the P
button again.

Playback and Deletion 187

Photo Information
Photo information is superimposed on images displayed in fullframe playback. Press 1 or 3 to cycle through photo
information as shown below. Note that “image only”, shooting
data, RGB histograms, highlights, and overview data are only
displayed if corresponding option is selected for Playback
display options (0 221). Location data are only displayed if
embedded in the picture (0 269).

File information

None (image only)

Overview

Highlights

Location data

RGB histogram

Shooting data

188 Playback and Deletion

❚❚ File Information
12 3

4

5
6

11
10
9

8

7

Protect status.......................... 200 7 Image size ................................100
Retouch indicator ................. 279 8 Time of recording...........40, 262
Upload marking..................... 203 9 Date of recording ...........40, 262
Frame number/total number of 10 Folder name ............................225
images
11 Rating ........................................201
5 File name.................................. 227
6 Image quality ............................98

1
2
3
4

❚❚ Highlights*
1

2

1 Folder number—frame

2 Image highlights

number.................................. 225
* Flashing areas indicate highlights (areas that may be overexposed).

Playback and Deletion 189

❚❚ RGB Histogram
1
2
3
4

5
1 Histogram (RGB channel). In all
histograms, horizontal axis
gives pixel brightness,
vertical axis number of pixels.
2 Histogram (red channel)

3 Histogram (green channel)
4 Histogram (blue channel)
5 White balance ........................ 140
White balance
fine-tuning....................... 143
Preset manual ..................... 145

A Playback Zoom
To zoom in on the photograph when the
histogram is displayed, press X. Use the X
and W (Q) buttons to zoom in and out and
scroll the image with the multi selector. The
histogram will be updated to show only the
data for the portion of the image visible in
the monitor.

190 Playback and Deletion

A Histograms
Camera histograms are intended as a guide only and may differ from
those displayed in imaging applications. Some sample histograms are
shown below:
If the image contains objects
with a wide range of
brightnesses, the distribution of
tones will be relatively even.
If the image is dark, tone
distribution will be shifted to the
left.
If the image is bright, tone
distribution will be shifted to the
right.
Increasing exposure compensation shifts the distribution of tones to
the right, while decreasing exposure compensation shifts the
distribution to the left. Histograms can provide a rough idea of overall
exposure when bright ambient lighting makes it difficult to see
photographs in the monitor.

Playback and Deletion 191

❚❚ Shooting Data
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
1 Metering .................................. 128
2
3
4
5

6 Focus mode................................82

Shutter speed......................... 118
Aperture................................... 118
Shooting
7
mode................. 47, 58, 65, 118
ISO sensitivity 1 ...................... 107 8
Exposure compensation .... 132 9
Focal length ............................ 314
10
Lens data

Lens VR (vibration
reduction) 2 ................... 32, 232
Flash type........................246, 315
Commander mode 2............. 246
Flash mode.....................102, 104
Flash control ........................... 246
Flash compensation............. 134
Camera name

1 Displayed in red if photo was taken with auto ISO sensitivity control on.
2 Displayed only in photos taken with accessories that support this function.

11
12
13

11 White balance ........................ 140 12 Color space.............................. 230
White balance
13 Picture Control * ..................... 155
fine-tuning ...................... 143
Preset manual..................... 145

* Items displayed vary with Picture Control selected.

192 Playback and Deletion

14
15
16
17
18
19

14 High ISO noise reduction ... 231 17 Vignette control.....................231
Long exposure noise
18 Retouch history......................277
reduction .............................. 230
19 Image comment ....................260
15 Active D-Lighting.................. 136
16 HDR (high dynamic
range)..................................... 138

20
21

20 Name of photographer *..... 261 21 Copyright holder * .................261
* Copyright information is only displayed if recorded with the photograph using the
Copyright information option in the setup menu.

Playback and Deletion 193

❚❚ Overview Data
123 4
56
16 17 18 19 20
7
8
28
27
26
25 24
9

15

14 13 12 11

22
23

10

Metering................................... 128
Shooting
mode................. 47, 58, 65, 118
Shutter speed......................... 118
Aperture ................................... 118
ISO sensitivity 1....................... 107
Focal length ............................ 314
Active D-Lighting.................. 136
Picture Control....................... 155
Color space.............................. 230
Flash mode.....................102, 104
White balance ........................ 140
White balance
Image size................................ 100
fine-tuning........................... 143
File name ................................. 227
Preset manual ........................ 145
Time of recording .......... 40, 262 27 Flash compensation............. 134
Commander mode 2............. 246
Date of recording........... 40, 262
Exposure compensation..... 132
28
Folder name............................ 225
Rating........................................ 201

1 Frame number/total number of 16
images
17
2 Upload marking .................... 203
3 Protect status ......................... 200 18
19
4 Camera name
5 Retouch indicator ................. 279 20
21
6 Image comment
indicator ............................... 260 22
7 Location data indicator ...... 269 23
8 Histogram showing the
24
distribution of tones in the
25
image (0 191).
26
Image
quality
............................98
9
10
11
12
13
14
15

21

1 Displayed in red if photo was taken with ISO sensitivity auto control on.
2 Displayed only in photos taken with accessories that support this function.

194 Playback and Deletion

❚❚ Location Data
The latitude, longitude, and other location data are supplied by
and vary with the GPS or smart device (0 269). In the case of
movies, the data give the location at the start of recording.

Playback and Deletion 195

Taking a Closer Look: Playback Zoom
Press the X button to zoom in on the image displayed in fullframe playback. The following operations can be performed
while zoom is in effect:
To

Use

Zoom in or out

X / W (Q)

View other areas
of image

Crop image

196 Playback and Deletion

P

Description
Press X to zoom in to maximum of
approximately 33× (large images),
25× (medium images) or 13× (small
images). Press W (Q) to zoom out.
While photo is zoomed in, use multi
selector to view areas of image not
visible in monitor. Keep multi selector
pressed to scroll rapidly to other areas
of frame. Navigation window is briefly
displayed when zoom ratio is altered;
area currently visible in monitor is
indicated by yellow border. Zoom
ratio is shown by bar at bottom of
navigation window; when zoom ratio
is 100%, bar is displayed green.

To crop image to area currently visible
in monitor, press P and select Trim
(0 198).

To

Use

Zoom in on faces

P

View other
images

Cancel zoom and return to full-frame
playback.

Cancel zoom
Return to
shooting mode

Description
To zoom in on faces detected by
camera, press P and select Face zoom
(0 199). This option is available only if
faces are detected. If faces are
detected when the RGB histogram
(0 190) display is zoomed in, Face
zoom will be available in the P-button
menu (Trim, however, will not be
available).
Rotate command dial to view same
location in other images at current
zoom ratio. Playback zoom is
cancelled when a movie is displayed.

K/

Press the K button or press the
shutter-release button halfway to exit
to shooting mode.

Playback and Deletion 197

❚❚ Cropping Photos
Follow the steps below to crop photos displayed during
playback zoom to the area currently visible in the monitor.

1 Press P.
After adjusting zoom and scrolling
the photo until only the area you wish
to keep is visible in the monitor, press
the P button.
P button

2 Select Trim.
Highlight Trim and press 2.

3 Select Done.
Highlight Done and press J to create
a cropped copy containing only the
portion of the image displayed in the
monitor.

198 Playback and Deletion

❚❚ Face Zoom
To zoom in on a face detected by the
camera, press the P button in the zoom
display and then highlight Face zoom
and press J.
P button

The current subject is indicated by a
white frame in the navigation window.
Press X or W (Q) to zoom in or out, or use
the multi selector to view other faces.

Playback and Deletion 199

Protecting Photographs from Deletion
Press the A (L) button to protect the current picture from
accidental deletion. Protected files are marked with a P icon
and can not be deleted using the O button or the Delete option
in the playback menu. Note that protected images will be
deleted when the memory card is formatted (0 259). To remove
protection from a picture so that it can be deleted, display or
highlight it and press the A (L) button.

A (L) button

A Removing Protection from All Images
To remove protection from all images in the folder or folders currently
selected in the Playback folder menu (0 221), press the A (L) and
O buttons together for about two seconds during playback.

200 Playback and Deletion

Rating Pictures
Rate pictures or mark them as candidates for later deletion.
Ratings can also be viewed in ViewNX-i and Capture NX-D.
Rating is not available with protected images.

Rating Individual Pictures

1 Select an image.
Display or highlight the image.

2 Display playback options.
Press the P button to display playback
options.

P button

3 Select Rating.
Highlight Rating and press 2.

4 Choose a rating.
Press 1 or 3 to choose a rating of
from zero to five stars, or select ) to
mark the picture as a candidate for
later deletion. Press J to complete
the operation.

Playback and Deletion 201

Rating Multiple Pictures
Use the Rating option in the playback menu to rate multiple
pictures.

1 Select Rating.
Highlight Rating in the playback
menu and press 2.

2 Rate pictures.
Press 4 or 2 to highlight pictures (to
view the currently highlighted picture
full frame, press and hold the X
button) and press 1 or 3 to choose a
rating of from zero to five stars, or
select ) to mark the picture as a candidate for later deletion.
Press J to complete the operation.

202 Playback and Deletion

Selecting Photos for Upload
Follow the steps below to select photos for upload to the smart
device before connecting. Movies can not be selected for
upload.

Selecting Individual Photos

1 Select a photo.
Display the photo or highlight it in the thumbnail list in
thumbnail playback.

2 Display playback options.
Press the P button to display playback
options.

P button

3 Choose Select to send to smart
device/deselect.
Highlight Select to send to smart
device/deselect and press J.
Pictures selected for upload are
indicated by a & icon; to deselect,
display or highlight the image and
repeat Steps 2 and 3.

Playback and Deletion 203

Selecting Multiple Photos
Follow the steps below to change the upload status of multiple
photos.

1 Choose Select image(s).
In the playback menu, select Select to
send to smart device, then highlight
Select image(s) and press 2.

2 Select photos.
Use the multi selector to highlight photos and press the
W (Q) button to select or deselect (to view the highlighted
picture full screen, press and hold the X button). Selected
photos are marked by a & icon.

3 Press J.
Press J to complete the operation.

A Deselecting All Photos
To deselect all photos, select Select to send to smart device in the
playback menu, highlight Deselect all, and press 2. A confirmation
dialog will be displayed; highlight Yes and press J to remove upload
marking from all photos on the memory card.

204 Playback and Deletion

Deleting Photographs
To delete the current photograph, press the O button. To delete
multiple selected photographs, all photographs taken on a
selected date, or all photographs in the current playback folder,
use the Delete option in the playback menu. Once deleted,
photographs can not be recovered. Note that pictures that are
protected can not be deleted.

During Playback
Press the O button to delete the current photograph.

1 Press the O button.
A confirmation dialog will be
displayed.

O button

2 Press the O button again.
To delete the photograph, press the O
button again. To exit without deleting
the photograph, press the K button.

A Calendar Playback
During calendar playback, you can delete all photographs taken on a
selected date by highlighting the date in the date list and pressing the
O button (0 186).

Playback and Deletion 205

The Playback Menu
The Delete option in the playback menu contains the following
options. Note that depending on the number of images, some
time may be required for deletion.
Option
Q Selected
n Select date
R All

Description
Delete selected pictures.
Delete all pictures taken on a selected date
(0 207).
Delete all pictures in the folder currently selected
for playback (0 221).

❚❚ Selected: Deleting Selected Photographs

1 Select pictures.
Use the multi selector to highlight a
picture and press the W (Q) button to
select or deselect (to view the
highlighted picture full screen, press
and hold the X button). Selected
W (Q) button
pictures are marked by a O icon.
Repeat as desired to select additional
pictures.

2 Press J to complete the operation.
A confirmation dialog will be
displayed; highlight Yes and press J.

206 Playback and Deletion

❚❚ Select Date: Deleting Photographs Taken on a Selected Date

1 Select dates.
Highlight a date and press 2 to select
all pictures taken on the highlighted
date. Selected dates are indicated by
check marks. Repeat as desired to
select additional dates; to deselect a
date, highlight it and press 2.

2 Press J to complete the operation.
A confirmation dialog will be
displayed; highlight Yes and press J.

Playback and Deletion 207

Slide Shows
The Slide show option in the playback menu is used to display a
slide show of the pictures in the current playback folder (0 221).

1 Select Slide show.
Highlight Slide show in the playback
menu and press 2.

2 Start the slide show.
Highlight Start in the slide show
menu and press J.

The following operations can be performed while the slide
show is in progress:
To

Use

Description

Skip back/
skip ahead

Press 4 to return to previous frame, 2 to
skip to next frame.

View
additional
photo info

Change photo info displayed (0 188).
Pause slide show. Select Restart to
resume.

Pause
Raise/lower
volume
Exit to
playback
mode

X/
W (Q)

208 Playback and Deletion

K

Press X during movie playback to increase
volume, W (Q) to decrease.
End show and return to playback mode.

The dialog shown at right is displayed
when the show ends. Select Restart to
restart or Exit to return to the playback
menu.

Slide Show Options
Before starting a slide show, you can use the options in the slide
show menu to select the images displayed by type or rating and
choose how long each image is displayed.
• Image type: Choose from Still images
and movies, Still images only,
Movies only, and By rating. To
include only pictures with selected
ratings, highlight By rating and press
2. A list of ratings will be displayed;
highlight ratings and press 2 to select
or deselect pictures with the
highlighted rating for inclusion in the
slide show. Selected ratings are
indicated by a check mark. Press J to
exit when the desired ratings are selected.
• Frame interval: Choose how long still
images are displayed.

Playback and Deletion 209

Connections
Installing ViewNX-i
To fine-tune photos and upload and view pictures, download
the latest version of the ViewNX-i installer from the following
website and follow the on-screen instructions to complete
installation. An Internet connection is required. For system
requirements and other information, see the Nikon website for
your region.
http://downloadcenter.nikonimglib.com/

A Capture NX-D
Use Nikon’s Capture NX-D software to fine-tune photos or to change
settings for NEF (RAW) pictures and save them in other formats.
Capture NX-D is available for download from:
http://downloadcenter.nikonimglib.com/

210 Connections

Copying Pictures to the Computer
Before proceeding, be sure you have installed ViewNX-i (0 210).

1 Connect the USB cable.
After turning the camera off and ensuring that a memory
card is inserted, connect a USB cable (available separately) as
shown and then turn the camera on.

D USB Hubs
Connect the camera directly to the computer; do not connect the
cable via a USB hub or keyboard.

A Use a Reliable Power Source
To ensure that data transfer is not interrupted, be sure the camera
battery is fully charged.

A Connecting Cables
Be sure the camera is off when connecting or disconnecting
interface cables. Do not use force or attempt to insert the
connectors at an angle.

Connections 211

2 Start Nikon Transfer 2 component of ViewNX-i.
If a message is displayed prompting you to choose a
program, select Nikon Transfer 2.
D During Transfer
Do not turn the camera off or disconnect the USB cable while
transfer is in progress.

A Windows 7
If the following dialog is displayed, select Nikon Transfer 2 as
described below.
1 Under Import pictures and videos,
click Change program. A program
selection dialog will be displayed;
select Nikon Transfer 2 and click OK.
2 Double-click

.

A Windows 10 and Windows 8.1
Windows 10 and Windows 8.1 may
display an AutoPlay prompt when the
camera is connected. Tap or click the
dialog and then tap or click
Nikon Transfer 2 to select
Nikon Transfer 2.

A OS X
If Nikon Transfer 2 does not start automatically, confirm that the
camera is connected and then launch Image Capture (an
application that comes with OS X) and select Nikon Transfer 2 as
the application that opens when the camera is detected.

212 Connections

3 Click Start Transfer.
Pictures on the memory card will be copied to the computer.

Start Transfer

4 Terminate the connection.
When transfer is complete, turn the camera off and
disconnect the USB cable.

A For More Information
Consult online help for more information on using ViewNX-i.

Connections 213

Printing Photographs
Selected JPEG images can be printed on a PictBridge printer
(0 365) connected directly to the camera.

Connecting the Printer
Connect the camera using a USB cable (available separately). Do
not use force or attempt to insert the connectors at an angle.

When the camera and printer are turned on, a welcome screen
will be displayed in the monitor, followed by a PictBridge
playback display.

D Selecting Photographs for Printing
NEF (RAW) photographs (0 98) can not be selected for printing. JPEG
copies of NEF (RAW) images can be created using the NEF (RAW)
processing option in the retouch menu (0 280).

D Date Imprint
If you select On for Print date in the PictBridge menu when printing
photographs containing date information recorded using Custom
Setting d4 (Date stamp; 0 243), the date will appear twice. The
imprinted date may however be cropped out if the photographs are
cropped or printed without a border.

214 Connections

Printing Pictures One at a Time

1 Display the desired picture.
Press 4 or 2 to view additional pictures. Press the X button
to zoom in on the current frame (0 196; press K to exit
zoom). To view eight pictures at a time, press the W (Q)
button. Use the multi selector to highlight pictures, or press
X to display the highlighted picture full frame.

2 Adjust printing options.
Press J to display the following items, then press 1 or 3 to
highlight an item and press 2 to view options (only options
supported by the current printer are listed; to use the default
option, select Printer default). After selecting an option,
press J to return to the printer settings menu.
Option
Page size

Description
Choose a page size.
This option is listed only when pictures are printed
No. of copies one at a time. Press 1 or 3 to choose number of
copies (maximum 99).
Border
Choose whether to frame photos in white borders.
Choose whether to print the times and dates of
Print date
recordings on photos.
This option is listed only when pictures are printed
one at a time. To exit without cropping, highlight No
cropping and press J. To crop the current picture,
highlight Crop and press 2. A crop selection dialog
Cropping
will be displayed; press X to increase the size of the
crop, W (Q) to decrease, and use the multi selector to
position the crop. Note that print quality may drop if
small crops are printed at large sizes.

Connections 215

3 Start printing.
Select Start printing and press J to start printing. To cancel
before all copies have been printed, press J.

Printing Multiple Pictures

1 Display the PictBridge menu.
Press the G button in the PictBridge playback display.

2 Choose an option.
Highlight one of the following options and press 2.
• Print select: Select pictures for printing. Press 4 or 2 to scroll
through pictures (to view the highlighted picture full
screen, press and hold theX button) and press 1 or 3 to
choose the number of prints. To deselect a picture, set the
number of prints to zero.
• Select date: Print one copy of all the pictures taken on a
selected date. Press 1 or 3 to highlight a date and press 2
to select or deselect. To view the pictures taken on the
selected date, press W (Q). Use the multi selector to scroll
through the pictures, or press and hold X to view the
current picture full screen. Press W (Q) again to return to
the date selection dialog.
• Index print: To create an index print of all JPEG pictures on the
memory card, proceed to Step 3. Note that if the memory
card contains more than 256 pictures, only the first 256
images will be printed. A warning will be displayed if the
page size selected in Step 3 is too small for an index print.

216 Connections

3 Adjust printer settings.
Adjust printer settings as described in Step 2 on page 215.

4 Start printing.
Select Start printing and press J to start printing. To cancel
before all copies have been printed, press J.

Connections 217

Viewing Pictures on TV
The optional High-Definition Multimedia Interface (HDMI) cable
(0 324) can be used to connect the camera to high-definition
video devices. Always turn the camera off before connecting or
disconnecting an HDMI cable.

Connect to
camera

Connect to high-definition device
(choose cable with connector for
HDMI device)

Tune the device to the HDMI channel, then turn the camera
on and press the K button. During playback, images will be
displayed on the television screen. Note that the edges of
images may not be displayed.

A Playback Volume
Volume can be adjusted using television controls; the camera controls
can not be used.

A Television Playback
Use of an AC adapter (available separately) is recommended for
extended playback.

218 Connections

❚❚ Choosing an Output Resolution
To choose the format for images output
to the HDMI device, select HDMI >
Output resolution in the camera setup
menu (0 258). If Auto is selected, the
camera will automatically select the
appropriate format.

❚❚ Controlling the Camera with the TV Remote
If On is selected for HDMI >Device control in the setup menu
(0 258) when the camera is connected to a television that
supports HDMI-CEC and both the camera and television are on,
the television remote can be used in place of the camera multi
selector and J button during full-frame playback and slide
shows. If Off is selected, the television remote can not be used
to control the camera, but the camera can be used to shoot
photographs and movies in live view.

A HDMI-CEC Devices
HDMI-CEC (High-Definition Multimedia Interface–Consumer
Electronics Control) is a standard that allows HDMI devices to be used
to control peripherals to which they are connected. When the camera
is connected to an HDMI-CEC device, ) will appear in the viewfinder
in place of the number of exposures remaining.

A 1920 × 1080 60p/50p
Selecting 1920 × 1080; 60p or 1920 × 1080; 50p for Movie settings
> Frame size/frame rate may cause variations in the resolution and
frame rate of the data output to HDMI devices during recording.

D HDMI > Output Resolution
Movies can not be output at resolutions of 1920 × 1080; 60p or
1920 × 1080; 50p. Some devices may not support an Output
resolution setting of Auto.

Connections 219

Camera Menus
D The Playback Menu: Managing Images
To display the playback menu, press G and select the D
(playback menu) tab.

G button

Playback Menu Options
The playback menu contains the following options:
Option
Delete
Playback folder
Playback display options
Image review
Auto image rotation
Rotate tall
Slide show
Image type
Frame interval
Rating
Select to send to smart device

220 D The Playback Menu: Managing Images

Default
—
All
—
On
On
On
Still images and movies
2s
—
—

0
206
221
221
221
222
222
208
202
204

Playback Folder
G button ➜ D playback menu

Choose a folder for playback:
Option

Description
Pictures in all folders created with the D5600 will be visible
during playback.
All
Pictures in all folders will be visible during playback.
Only photos in the folder currently selected for Storage
Current folder in the shooting menu (0 225) are displayed during
playback.
D5600

Playback Display Options
G button ➜ D playback menu

Choose the information available in the
playback photo information display
(0 188). Press 1 or 3 to highlight and
press 2 to select or deselect. Selected
items are indicated by check marks. To
return to the playback menu, press J.

Image Review
G button ➜ D playback menu

Choose whether pictures are automatically displayed in the
monitor immediately after shooting. If Off is selected, pictures
can only be displayed by pressing the D button.

D The Playback Menu: Managing Images 221

Auto Image Rotation
G button ➜ D playback menu

Photographs taken while On is selected contain information on
camera orientation, allowing them to be rotated automatically
during playback or when viewed in ViewNX-i or in Capture NX-D
(0 210). The following orientations are recorded:

Landscape (wide)
orientation

Camera rotated 90°
clockwise

Camera rotated 90°
counterclockwise

Camera orientation is not recorded when Off is selected.
Choose this option when panning or taking photographs with
the lens pointing up or down.

Rotate Tall
G button ➜ D playback menu

If On is selected, “tall” (portrait-orientation) pictures will be
automatically rotated for display in the monitor (pictures taken
with Off selected for Auto image rotation will still be displayed
in landscape orientation). Note that because the camera itself is
already in the appropriate orientation during shooting, images
are not rotated automatically during image review.

222 D The Playback Menu: Managing Images

C The Shooting Menu: Shooting Options
To display the shooting menu, press G and select the
C (shooting menu) tab.

G button

Shooting Menu Options
The shooting menu contains the following options:
Option
Reset shooting menu
Storage folder
File naming
Image quality
Image size
NEF (RAW) recording
ISO sensitivity settings
ISO sensitivity
P, S, A, M
Other modes
Auto ISO sensitivity control
White balance
Fluorescent
Set Picture Control
Manage Picture Control
Color space
Active D-Lighting
HDR (high dynamic range)

Default
—
—
DSC
JPEG normal
Large
14-bit
100
Auto
Off
Auto
Cool-white fluorescent
Standard
—
sRGB
Auto
Off

0
225
225
227
98
100
227
107
228
140
141
155
161
230
136
138

C The Shooting Menu: Shooting Options 223

Option
Release mode
m, w
Other modes
Long exposure NR
High ISO NR
Vignette control
Auto distortion control
Optical VR *
Interval timer shooting
Start options
Interval
Number of times
Exposure smoothing
Time-lapse movie
Interval
Shooting time
Exposure smoothing
Movie settings
Frame size/frame rate
Movie quality
Microphone
Wind noise reduction
Manual movie settings

Default

0

Continuous H
Single frame
Off
Normal
Normal
Off
On

230
231
231
232
232

Now
1 min.
1
Off

110
110
111
111

5 sec.
25 sec.
On

172
172
173

1920 × 1080; 60p
Normal
Auto sensitivity
Off
Off

168

75

* Available only with lenses that support this item.
Note: Depending on camera settings, some items may be grayed out and
unavailable.

224 C The Shooting Menu: Shooting Options

Reset Shooting Menu
G button ➜ C shooting menu

Select Yes to reset shooting menu settings.

Storage Folder
G button ➜ C shooting menu

Select the folder in which subsequent images will be stored.

❚❚ Selecting Folders by Folder Number

1 Choose Select folder by number.
Highlight Select folder by number and press 2.

2 Choose a folder number.
Press 4 or 2 to highlight a digit, press 1 or 3 to change. If a
folder with the selected number already exists, a W, X, or Y
icon will be displayed to the left of the folder number:
• W : Folder is empty.
• X : Folder is partially full.
• Y : Folder contains 999 pictures or a picture numbered
9999. No further pictures can be stored in this folder.

3 Save changes and exit.
Press J to complete the operation and return to the main
menu (to exit without choosing the storage folder, press the
G button). If a folder with the specified number does not
already exist, a new folder will be created. Subsequent
photographs will be stored in the selected folder unless it is
already full.

C The Shooting Menu: Shooting Options 225

❚❚ Selecting Folders from a List

1 Choose Select folder from list.
Highlight Select folder from list and
press 2.

2 Highlight a folder.
Press 1 or 3 to highlight a folder.

3 Select the highlighted folder.
Press J to select the highlighted folder and return to the
main menu. Subsequent photographs will be stored in the
selected folder.
D Folder and File Numbers
If the current folder is numbered 999 and contains 999 pictures or a
picture numbered 9999, the shutter-release will be disabled and no
further photographs can be taken. To continue shooting, create a
folder with a number less than 999, or select an existing folder with a
number less than 999 and less than 999 images.

A Startup Time
Additional time may be required for camera startup if the memory card
contains a very large number of files or folders.

226 C The Shooting Menu: Shooting Options

File Naming
G button ➜ C shooting menu

Photographs are saved using file names consisting of “DSC_” or,
in the case of images that use the Adobe RGB color space
(0 230), “_DSC”, followed by a four-digit number and a threeletter extension (e.g., “DSC_0001.JPG”). The File naming option
is used to select three letters to replace the “DSC” portion of the
file name. For information on editing file names, see page 162.
A Extensions
The following extensions are used: “.NEF” for NEF (RAW) images, “.JPG”
for JPEG images, “.MOV” for movies, and “.NDF” for dust off reference
data. In each pair of photographs recorded at image-quality settings of
NEF (RAW)+JPEG, the NEF and JPEG images have the same file names
but different extensions.

NEF (RAW) Recording
G button ➜ C shooting menu

Choose the bit depth for NEF (RAW) images.
Option
( 12-bit

) 14-bit

Description
NEF (RAW) images are recorded at a bit depth of 12
bits.
NEF (RAW) images are recorded at a bit depth of
14 bits, producing files larger than those with a bit
depth of 12 bits but increasing the color data
recorded.

C The Shooting Menu: Shooting Options 227

ISO Sensitivity Settings
G button ➜ C shooting menu

Adjust ISO sensitivity (0 107).

❚❚ Auto ISO Sensitivity control
If Off is chosen for Auto ISO sensitivity control in P, S, A, and M
modes, ISO sensitivity will remain fixed at the value selected by
the user (0 107). When On is chosen, ISO sensitivity will
automatically be adjusted if optimal exposure can not be
achieved at the value selected by the user. The maximum value
for auto ISO sensitivity can be selected using the Maximum
sensitivity option in the Auto ISO sensitivity control menu
(choose lower values to prevent noise (randomly-spaced bright
pixels, fog, or lines), but note that if the ISO sensitivity selected
by the user is higher than that chosen for Maximum sensitivity,
the value selected by the user will be used instead; the minimum
value for auto ISO sensitivity is automatically set to ISO 100). In
modes P and A, sensitivity will only be adjusted if underexposure
would result at the shutter speed selected for Minimum shutter
speed (1/2000–30 s, or Auto; in modes S and M, sensitivity will be
adjusted for optimal exposure at the shutter speed selected by
the user). If Auto (available only with CPU lenses) is selected, the
camera will choose the minimum shutter speed based on the
focal length of the lens (auto shutter-speed selection can be
fine-tuned by highlighting Auto and pressing 2). Slower
shutter speeds will be used only if optimal exposure can not be
achieved at the ISO sensitivity value selected for Maximum
sensitivity.

228 C The Shooting Menu: Shooting Options

When On is selected, the viewfinder
shows ISO AUTO and the information
display ISO-A. These indicators flash when
sensitivity is altered from the value
selected by the user.

A Maximum Sensitivity/Minimum Shutter Speed
When auto ISO sensitivity control is
enabled, the ISO sensitivity and shutter
speed graphics in the information
display show the maximum sensitivity
and minimum shutter speed.

Minimum shutter speed

Maximum sensitivity

A Auto ISO Sensitivity Control
Note that ISO sensitivity may be raised automatically when auto ISO
sensitivity control is used in combination with slow sync flash modes
(available with the built-in flash and the optional flash units listed on
page 315), possibly preventing the camera from selecting slow shutter
speeds.

C The Shooting Menu: Shooting Options 229

Color Space
G button ➜ C shooting menu

The color space determines the gamut of colors available for
color reproduction. sRGB is recommended for general-purpose
printing and display; Adobe RGB, with its broader gamut of
colors, for professional publication and commercial printing.
Regardless of the option selected, movies are recorded in sRGB.
A Adobe RGB
For accurate color reproduction, Adobe RGB images require
applications, displays, and printers that support color management.

A Color Space
ViewNX-i and Capture NX-D automatically select the correct color
space when opening photographs created with this camera. Results
can not be guaranteed with third-party software.

Long Exposure NR
G button ➜ C shooting menu

If On is selected, photographs taken at
shutter speeds slower than 1 s will be
processed to reduce noise (bright spots
or fog). The time required for processing roughly doubles;
during processing, “l m” will flash in the shutter speed/
aperture displays and pictures can not be taken (if the camera is
turned off before processing is complete, the picture will be
saved but noise reduction will not be performed). In continuous
release mode, frame rates will slow and while photographs are
being processed, the capacity of the memory buffer will drop.

230 C The Shooting Menu: Shooting Options

High ISO NR
G button ➜ C shooting menu

Photographs taken at high ISO sensitivities can be processed to
reduce “noise.”
Option
High

Description
Reduce noise (randomly-spaced bright pixels), particularly
in photographs taken at high ISO sensitivities. Choose the
Normal
amount of noise reduction performed from High, Normal,
Low
and Low.
Noise reduction is performed only as required and never at
Off
an amount as high as when Low is selected.

Vignette Control
G button ➜ C shooting menu

“Vignetting” is a drop in brightness at the edges of a
photograph. Vignette control reduces vignetting for type G, E,
and D lenses (PC lenses excluded). Its effects vary from lens to
lens and are most noticeable at maximum aperture. Choose
from High, Normal, Low, and Off.
A Vignette Control
Depending on the scene, shooting conditions, and type of lens, JPEG
images may exhibit noise (fog) or variations in peripheral brightness,
while custom Picture Controls and preset Picture Controls that have
been modified from default settings may not produce the desired
effect. Take test shots and view the results in the monitor. Vignette
control does not apply to movies (0 164) or to pictures taken with
lenses that support FX format.

C The Shooting Menu: Shooting Options 231

Auto Distortion Control
G button ➜ C shooting menu

Select On to reduce barrel distortion when shooting with wideangle lenses and to reduce pin-cushion distortion when
shooting with long lenses (note that the edges of the area visible
in the viewfinder may be cropped out of the final photograph,
and that the time needed to process photographs before
recording begins may increase). This option does not apply to
movies and is available only with type G, E, and D lenses (PC,
fisheye, and certain other lenses excluded); results are not
guaranteed with other lenses.
A Retouch: Distortion Control
For information on creating copies of existing photographs with
reduced barrel and pin-cushion distortion, see page 287.

Optical VR
G button ➜ C shooting menu

This item is displayed only with lenses that support it. Selecting
On enables vibration reduction, which takes effect whenever
the shutter-release button is pressed halfway (0 372). Select Off
to disable vibration reduction.
A The Vibration Reduction Indicator
A vibration reduction indicator appears in
the information display when On is selected
for Optical VR.

232 C The Shooting Menu: Shooting Options

A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings
To display the Custom Settings menu, press G and select the
A (Custom Settings menu) tab.

G button

Custom Settings are used to customize camera settings to suit
individual preferences.
Main menu

Custom Setting groups

Reset custom
settings (0 235)

A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings 233

Custom Settings
The following Custom Settings are available:

a
a1
a2
a3
a4
a5
b
b1
b2
c
c1
c2
c3

Custom Setting
Reset custom settings
Autofocus
AF-C priority selection
Number of focus points
Built-in AF-assist illuminator
Rangefinder
Manual focus ring in AF mode *
Exposure
EV steps for exposure cntrl
ISO display
Timers/AE lock
Shutter-release button AE-L
Auto off timers
Self-timer

Shooting/display
Exposure delay mode
File number sequence
Viewfinder grid display
Date stamp
Reverse indicators
Bracketing/flash
Flash cntrl for built-in flash/
Optional flash
e2 Auto bracketing set

Default

0
235

Focus
39 points
On
Off
Enable

235
236
237
237
238

1/3 step
Off

239
239

Off
Normal
Self-timer delay: 10 s;
Number of shots: 1

239
240

d
d1
d2
d3
d4
d5
e
e1

Off
Off
Off
Off

241
241
242
243
243
245

TTL

246

AE bracketing

251

234 A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings

f
f1
f2
f3
f4

Custom Setting
Controls
Assign Fn button
Assign AE-L/AF-L button
Assign touch Fn
Reverse dial rotation

Default

0

ISO sensitivity
AE/AF lock
Viewfinder grid display
Exposure compensation: U
Shutter speed/aperture: U

252
254
255
256

* Available only with lenses that support this item.
Note: Depending on camera settings, some items may be grayed out and
unavailable.

Reset Custom Settings
G button ➜ A Custom Settings menu

Select Yes to restore Custom Settings to their default values.

a: Autofocus
a1: AF-C Priority Selection
G button ➜ A Custom Settings menu

When AF-C is selected for viewfinder photography (0 82), this
option controls whether photographs can be taken whenever
the shutter-release button is pressed (release priority) or only
when the camera is in focus (focus priority).
Option
G

Release

F Focus

Description
Photos can be taken whenever the shutter-release
button is pressed.
Photos can only be taken once the camera has
focused.

A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings 235

a2: Number of Focus Points
G button ➜ A Custom Settings menu

Choose the number of focus points available for manual focuspoint selection.
Option

Description
Choose from the 39 focus
points shown at right.

# 39 points

A 11 points

Choose from the 11 focus
points shown at right.
Use for quick focus-point
selection.

236 A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings

a3: Built-in AF-assist Illuminator
G button ➜ A Custom Settings menu

Choose whether the built-in AF-assist
illuminator lights to assist the focus
operation when lighting is poor.

Option
On
Off

AF-assist illuminator

Description
The AF-assist illuminator lights when lighting is poor (for
more information, see page 342).
The AF-assist illuminator does not light to assist the focus
operation. The camera may not be able to focus using
autofocus when lighting is poor.

a4: Rangefinder
G button ➜ A Custom Settings menu

Choose On to use the exposure indicator to determine whether
the camera is correctly focused in manual focus mode (0 95;
note that this function is not available in shooting mode M, when
the exposure indicator instead shows whether the subject is
correctly exposed).
Indicator

Description
Subject in focus.

Focus point is slightly in front of subject.

A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings 237

Indicator

Description
Focus point is well in front of subject.

Focus point is slightly behind subject.

Focus point is well behind subject.

Camera can not determine correct focus.

A Using the Electronic Rangefinder
The electronic rangefinder requires a lens with a maximum aperture of
f/5.6 or faster. The desired results may not be achieved in situations in
which the camera would be unable to focus using autofocus (0 86).
The electronic rangefinder is not available during live view.

a5: Manual Focus Ring in AF Mode
G button ➜ A Custom Settings menu

This item is displayed only with lenses that support it. Selecting
Enable allows the lens focus ring to be used for manual focus
when the camera is in autofocus mode; this is known as
“autofocus with manual override” (M/A). After pressing the
shutter-release button halfway to focus, keep the button
pressed halfway and adjust focus using the focus ring. To
refocus using autofocus, lift your finger from the shutter-release
button and then press it halfway again. To prevent the lens focus
ring being used for manual focus when the camera is in
autofocus mode, select Disable.

238 A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings

b: Exposure
b1: EV Steps for Exposure Cntrl
G button ➜ A Custom Settings menu

Select the increments used when making adjustments to shutter
speed, aperture, exposure and flash compensation, and
bracketing.

b2: ISO Display
G button ➜ A Custom Settings menu

Select On to display ISO sensitivity in the viewfinder in place of
the number of exposures remaining.

c: Timers/AE Lock
c1: Shutter-Release Button AE-L
G button ➜ A Custom Settings menu

If On is selected, exposure will lock when the shutter-release
button is pressed halfway.

A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings 239

c2: Auto off Timers
G button ➜ A Custom Settings menu

This option determines how long the monitor remains on if no
operations are performed during menu display and playback
(Playback/menus), while photographs are displayed in the
monitor after shooting (Image review), and during live view
(Live view), and how long the standby timer, viewfinder, and
information display remain on when no operations are
performed (Standby timer). Choose shorter auto-off delays to
reduce the drain on the battery.
Option

C Short
D Normal
E Long

F Custom

Description (all times are approximate)
Auto off timers are set to the following values:
Playback/
Image
Standby
Live view
menus
review
timer
Short
20 s
4s
5 min.
4s
Normal
5 min.
4s
10 min.
8s
Long
10 min.
20 s
20 min.
1 min.
Choose separate delays for Playback/menus, Image
review, Live view, and Standby timer. When settings
are complete, press J.

A Auto off Timers
The monitor and viewfinder will not turn off automatically when the
camera is connected to a computer or printer via USB.

240 A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings

c3: Self-Timer
G button ➜ A Custom Settings menu

Choose the length of the shutter release delay and the number
of shots taken.
• Self-timer delay: Choose the length of the shutter-release delay.
• Number of shots: Press 1 and 3 to choose the number of shots
taken each time the shutter-release button is pressed (from 1
to 9; if a value other than 1 is selected, shots will be taken at
intervals of about 4 seconds).

d: Shooting/Display
d1: Exposure Delay Mode
G button ➜ A Custom Settings menu

In situations where the slightest camera movement can blur
pictures, select On to delay shutter release until about 1 s after
the shutter-release button is pressed and the mirror is raised.

A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings 241

d2: File Number Sequence
G button ➜ A Custom Settings menu

When a photograph is taken, the camera names the file by
adding one to the last file number used. This option controls
whether file numbering continues from the last number used
when a new folder is created, the memory card is formatted, or a
new memory card is inserted in the camera.
Option

On

Off

Reset

Description
When a new folder is created, the memory card formatted, or
a new memory card inserted in the camera, file numbering
continues from the last number used or from the largest file
number in the current folder, whichever is higher. If a
photograph is taken when the current folder contains a
photograph numbered 9999, a new folder will be created
automatically and file numbering will begin again from 0001.
File numbering is reset to 0001 when a new folder is created,
the memory card formatted, or a new memory card inserted
in the camera. Note that a new folder is created
automatically if a photograph is taken when the current
folder contains 999 photographs.
As for On, except that the next photograph taken is assigned
a file number by adding one to the largest file number in the
current folder. If the folder is empty, file numbering is reset to
0001.

D File Number Sequence
If the current folder is numbered 999 and contains either 999
photographs or a photograph numbered 9999, the shutter-release
button will be disabled and no further photographs can be taken.
Choose Reset for Custom Setting d2 (File number sequence) and
then either format the current memory card or insert a new memory
card.

242 A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings

d3: Viewfinder Grid Display
G button ➜ A Custom Settings menu

Choose On to display on-demand grid lines in the viewfinder for
reference when composing photographs (0 5).

d4: Date Stamp
G button ➜ A Custom Settings menu

Choose the date information imprinted on photographs as they
are taken. Date stamps can not be added to or removed from
existing photos.
Option
Off

Description
The time and date do not appear on photographs.
The date or date and time
a Date
15 . 10 . 2016
are imprinted on
Date and photographs taken while
b
15 . 10 . 2016 10 :02
this option is in effect.
time
New photos are imprinted with a time stamp
Date
c
showing the number of days between the date of
counter
shooting and a selected date (see below).

At settings other than Off, the selected
option is indicated by a d icon in the
information display.
A Date Stamp
The date is recorded in the order selected for Time zone and date
(0 262). The imprinted data may be cropped out or rendered illegible
in copies created when images are retouched (0 277). The date does
not appear on NEF (RAW) or NEF (RAW)+JPEG images.

A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings 243

❚❚ Date Counter
Pictures taken while this option is in
effect are imprinted with the number of
days remaining until a future date or the
number of days elapsed since a past date.
Use it to track the growth of a child or
count down the days until a birthday or
wedding.
02 / 15 . 10 . 2016

Future date (two days remaining)

02 / 19 . 10 . 2016

Past date (two days elapsed)

The camera offers three slots for storing dates.

1 Enter the first date.
The first time you select Date counter,
you will be prompted to enter a date
for the first slot. Enter a date using the
multi selector and press J to exit to
the date list.

2 Enter additional dates or edit
existing dates.
To change a date or enter additional
dates, highlight a slot, press 2, and
enter a date as described above.

3 Choose a date.
Highlight a slot in the date list and press J.

244 A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings

4 Choose a date counter format.
Highlight Display options and press
2, then highlight a date format and
press J.

5 Exit the date counter menu.
Press J to exit the date counter menu.

d5: Reverse Indicators
G button ➜ A Custom Settings menu

If
(V) is selected, the exposure indicators in
the viewfinder and information display are displayed with
positive values on the left and negative values on the right.
Select
(W) to display negative values on
the left and positive values on the right.

A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings 245

e: Bracketing/Flash
e1: Flash Cntrl for Built-in Flash/Optional Flash
G button ➜ A Custom Settings menu

Choose the flash mode for the built-in flash in P, S, A, and M
modes. When an optional SB-500, SB-400, or SB-300 flash unit is
attached and turned on, this option changes to Optional flash
and is used to choose the flash mode for the optional flash unit.
Option

Description
Flash output is adjusted automatically in response
1 TTL
to shooting conditions.
Choose a flash level. At full power, the built-in
flash has a Guide Number of 12/39 (m/ft., ISO 100,
2 Manual
20 °C/68 °F).
This option is available when an optional SB-500
flash unit is mounted on the camera accessory
Commander
4
shoe. In commander mode, the SB-500 functions
mode
as a master flash for wireless remote control of
groups of optional off-camera flash units (0 247).

A Manual
A Y icon flashes in the viewfinder and 0
appears in the information display when
Manual is selected and the flash is on or
raised.

246 A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings

A TTL Flash Control
The following types of flash control are supported when a CPU lens is
used in combination with the built-in flash (0 101) or optional flash
units (0 315).
• i-TTL Balanced Fill-Flash for Digital SLR: Information from the 2016-pixel
RGB sensor is used to adjust flash output for a natural balance
between the main subject and the background.
• Standard i-TTL Fill-Flash for Digital SLR: Flash output is adjusted for the
main subject; the brightness of the background is not taken into
account.
Standard i-TTL flash control is used with spot metering or when
selected with the optional flash unit. i-TTL balanced fill-flash for digital
SLR is used in all other cases.

❚❚ Commander Mode
When an optional SB-500 flash unit is mounted on the accessory
shoe, select Commander mode to use the SB-500 as a master
flash controlling one or more remote optional flash units in up to
two groups (A and B) using advanced wireless lighting (0 315).
Selecting this option displays the menu
shown at right. Press 4 or 2 to highlight
the following options, 1 or 3 to change.

A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings 247

Option
Optional
flash
TTL
M
––
Group A
TTL
%A
M
––
Group B
Channel

Description
Choose a flash mode for the master (commander) flash.
i-TTL mode. Choose flash compensation from values
between +3.0 and –3.0 EV in increments of 1/3 EV.
Choose the flash level.
Only the remote flash units fire; the master flash does not,
although it does emit monitor pre-flashes.
Choose a flash mode for all flash units in group A.
i-TTL mode. Choose flash compensation from values
between +3.0 and –3.0 EV in increments of 1/3 EV.
Auto aperture (available only with compatible flash units;
0 315). Choose flash compensation from values between
+3.0 and –3.0 EV in increments of 1/3 EV.
Choose the flash level.
The flash units in this group do not fire.
Choose a flash mode for all flash units in group B. The
options available are the same as those listed for Group A,
above.
Choose from channels 1–4. All flash units in both groups
must be set to the same channel.

248 A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings

Follow the steps below to take photographs in commander
mode.

1 Adjust settings for the master flash.
Choose the flash control mode and
output level for the master flash. Note
that output level can not be adjusted
in – – mode.

2 Adjust settings for group A.
Choose the flash control mode and
output level for the flash units in
group A.

3 Adjust settings for group B.
Choose the flash control mode and
output level for the flash units in
group B.

4 Select the channel.
If the remote flash units include an
SB-500, select channel 3.

5 Press J.

A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings 249

6 Compose the shot.
Compose the shot and arrange the flash units as shown
below. Note that the maximum distance at which the remote
flash units can be placed may vary with shooting conditions.
Group A: 10 m/32 ft or less

Group B: 7 m/22 ft or less

60 ° or less

Master flash
(SB-500, mounted on camera)
Wireless remote sensors on flash units
should face camera.

7 Configure the remote flash units.
Turn all the remote flash units on, adjust group settings as
desired, and set them to the channel selected in Step 4. See
the flash unit instruction manuals for details.

8 Frame the photograph, focus, and shoot.
After confirming that the camera flash-ready light and the
flash-ready lights for all flash units are lit, frame the
photograph, focus, and shoot.
A The Flash Sync Mode Display
M does not appear in the information display when – – is selected for
Optional flash > Mode.

250 A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings

A Flash Compensation
The flash compensation value selected with the M (Y) and E (N)
buttons and command dial is added to the flash compensation values
selected for the master flash, group A, and group B in the Commander
mode menu. A Y icon is displayed in the viewfinder when a flash
compensation value other than ±0 is selected for the master or remote
flash units in TTL or %A mode.

D Commander Mode
Position the sensor windows on the remote flash units to pick up the
light from the master flash (particular care is required if the camera is
not mounted on a tripod). The remote flash units should normally be
placed closer to the subject than to the camera. Be sure that direct
light or strong reflections from the remote flash units do not enter the
camera lens (in TTL mode) or the photocells on the remote flash units
(%A mode), as this may interfere with exposure. To prevent timing
flashes emitted by the master flash from appearing in photographs
taken at short range, choose low ISO sensitivities or small apertures
(high f-numbers) or rotate the flash head on the master flash to point
upwards. After positioning the remote flash units, take a test shot and
view the results in the camera monitor.
Although there is no limit on the number of remote flash units that
may be used, the practical maximum is three. With more than this
number, the light emitted by the remote flash units will interfere with
performance.

e2: Auto Bracketing Set
G button ➜ A Custom Settings menu

Choose the setting (exposure, white balance, or Active
D-Lighting) varied when bracketing is in effect (0 151).

A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings 251

f: Controls
f1: Assign Fn Button
G button ➜ A Custom Settings menu

Choose the role played by the Fn button.

Fn button
Option

Description
Keeping the Fn button pressed, rotate the
Image
v
command dial to select image quality and size
quality/size
(0 98).
ISO
Keeping the Fn button pressed, rotate the
w
sensitivity command dial to select ISO sensitivity (0 107).
Keeping the Fn button pressed, rotate the
White
m
command dial to select white balance (P, S, A, and M
balance
modes only; 0 140).
Keeping the Fn button pressed, rotate the
Active
!
command dial to select Active D-Lighting (P, S, A,
D-Lighting
and M modes only; 0 136).
Keeping the Fn button pressed, rotate the
$ HDR
command dial to adjust HDR (P, S, A, and M modes
only; 0 138).
If image quality is set to JPEG fine, JPEG normal,
or JPEG basic, an NEF (RAW) copy will be recorded
with the next picture taken after the Fn button is
& +NEF (RAW) pressed. To exit without recording an NEF (RAW)
copy, press the Fn button again. This option has no
effect in the following special effects modes: %, S,
T, U, ', (, and 3.

252 A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings

Option

t

Auto
bracketing

"

AF-area
mode

'

Viewfinder
grid display

c

Wi-Fi

Description
Keeping the Fn button pressed, rotate the
command dial to choose the bracketing increment
(exposure and white balance bracketing) or to turn
ADL bracketing on or off (P, S, A, and M modes only;
0 151).
Keeping the Fn button pressed, rotate the
command dial to choose an AF-area mode (0 87).
Press the Fn button to
display or hide the
viewfinder framing grid.

Press the Fn button to display the Wi-Fi menu
(0 272).

A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings 253

f2: Assign AE-L/AF-L Button
G button ➜ A Custom Settings menu

Choose the role played by the A (L)
button.

A (L) button
Option

Description
Focus and exposure lock while the A (L) button
B AE/AF lock
is pressed.
C AE lock only Exposure locks while the A (L) button is pressed.
Exposure locks when the A (L) button is
AE lock
pressed, and remains locked until the button is
E
(Hold)
pressed a second time or the standby timer
expires.
F AF lock only Focus locks while the A (L) button is pressed.
The A (L) button initiates autofocus. The
A AF-ON
shutter-release button can not be used to focus.

254 A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings

f3: Assign Touch Fn
G button ➜ A Custom Settings menu

A touch-sensitive area of the monitor can be used to control the
camera after the monitor has turned off automatically. The
position of this “touch Fn” area varies with the position of the
monitor; the role it plays can be chosen from the options in the
table below. Slide your finger left or right across the area
indicated in the illustration to adjust the chosen option (note
that touch Fn is not available when the monitor is facing
forward). If you find that your face contacts the touch Fn area
when you look through the viewfinder, use the monitor in the
extended position.
Touch Fn area

Monitor in normal position

Monitor extended

Option

Description
When an option other than e (Auto-area AF) is
Focus-point selected for AF-area mode, you can slide a finger
#
selection
over the touch Fn area to position the focus point
(0 90).
Slide a finger left or right over the touch Fn area to
ISO
adjust ISO sensitivity (0 107), up or down to turn
w
sensitivity auto ISO sensitivity control (0 228) on or off (P, S, A,
and M modes only).
Slide a finger over the touch Fn area to adjust
Active
!
Active D-Lighting (P, S, A, and M modes only;
D-Lighting
0 136).

A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings 255

Option
$ HDR

t

Auto
bracketing

"

AF-area
mode

'

Viewfinder
grid display

%

Aperture

None

Description
Slide a finger over the touch Fn area to adjust HDR
(P, S, A, and M modes only; 0 138).
Slide a finger over the touch Fn area to choose the
bracketing increment (exposure and white
balance bracketing) or to turn ADL bracketing on
or off (P, S, A, and M modes only; 0 151).
Slide a finger over the touch Fn area to choose an
AF-area mode (0 87).
Tap the touch Fn area to
display or hide the
viewfinder framing grid.

Slide a finger over the touch Fn area to adjust
aperture (A and M modes only; 0 122, 123).
Disable touch Fn.

D Touch Fn
Touch Fn is available only if Enable is selected for Touch controls
(0 263) and Info display auto off (0 265) is on.

f4: Reverse Dial Rotation
G button ➜ A Custom Settings menu

Reverse the direction of rotation of the
command dial when it is used to make
adjustments to exposure or flash
compensation (Exposure
compensation) and/or shutter speed
and aperture (Shutter speed/aperture).
Highlight options and press 2 to select or deselect, then press
J.

256 A Custom Settings: Fine-Tuning Camera Settings

B The Setup Menu: Camera Setup
To display the setup menu, press G and select the B (setup
menu) tab.

G button

Setup Menu Options
The setup menu contains the following options:
Option
Format memory card
Image comment
Copyright information
Time zone and date 1
Sync with smart device
Daylight saving time
Language 1
Beep options
Beep on/off
Pitch
Touch controls
Monitor brightness
Info display format
AUTO/SCENE/EFFECTS
P/S/A/M
Auto info display
Info display auto off
Clean image sensor
Clean at startup/shutdown

Default
—
—
—

0
259
260
261

Off
Off
—

262

On
Low
Enable
0

263
263
263
263

Graphic
Graphic
On
On
Clean at startup &
shutdown

262

264
265
265
328

B The Setup Menu: Camera Setup 257

Option
Lock mirror up for cleaning 2
Image Dust Off ref photo
Flicker reduction
Slot empty release lock
HDMI
Output resolution
Device control
Location data
Download from smart device
Position
External GPS device options
Standby timer
Set clock from satellite
Remote control
Remote shutter release
Assign Fn button
Airplane mode
Connect to smart device
Send to smart device (auto)
Wi-Fi
Network settings
Current settings
Reset connection settings
Bluetooth
Network connection
Paired devices
Send while off
Eye-Fi upload 3

258 B The Setup Menu: Camera Setup

Default
—
—
Auto
Release locked

0
330
266
268
268

Auto
On

219

No
—
269
Enable
Yes
Take photos
Same as camera 4 button
Disable
—
Off

270
270
271
271
272

—
—
—

272

Disable
—
On
Enable

273
274

Option
Conformity marking
Firmware version

Default
—
—

0
276
276

1 Default varies with country of purchase.
2 Not available when battery is low.
3 Only available when compatible Eye-Fi memory card is inserted.
Note: Depending on camera settings, some items may be grayed out and
unavailable.

Format Memory Card
G button ➜ B setup menu

Memory cards must be formatted before first use or after being
formatted in other devices. Format the card as described below.
D Formatting Memory Cards
Formatting memory cards permanently deletes any data they may
contain. Be sure to copy any photographs and other data you wish to
keep to a computer before proceeding (0 211).

1 Highlight Yes.
To exit without formatting the
memory card, highlight No and press
J.

2 Press J.
A message will be displayed while the
card is formatted. Do not remove the
memory card or remove or disconnect
the power source until formatting is
complete.

B The Setup Menu: Camera Setup 259

Image Comment
G button ➜ B setup menu

Add a comment to new photographs as they are taken.
Comments can be viewed as metadata in ViewNX-i or
Capture NX-D. The comment is also visible on the shooting data
page in the photo information display (0 193). The following
options are available:
• Input comment: Input a comment as described on page 162.
Comments can be up to 36 characters long.
• Attach comment: Select this option to
attach the comment to all subsequent
photographs. Attach comment can
be turned on and off by highlighting it
and pressing 2. After choosing the
desired setting, press J to exit.

260 B The Setup Menu: Camera Setup

Copyright Information
G button ➜ B setup menu

Add copyright information to new photographs as they are
taken. Copyright information is included in the shooting data
shown in the photo information display and can be viewed as
metadata in ViewNX-i or in Capture NX-D. The following options
are available:
• Artist: Enter a photographer name as described on page 162.
Photographer names can be up to 36 characters long.
• Copyright: Enter the name of the copyright holder as described
on page 162. Copyright holder names can be up to 54
characters long.
• Attach copyright information: Select this
option to attach copyright
information to all subsequent
photographs. Attach copyright
information can be turned on and off
by highlighting it and pressing 2.
After choosing the desired setting,
press J to exit.
D Copyright Information
To prevent unauthorized use of the artist or copyright holder names,
make sure that Attach copyright information is not selected and that
the Artist and Copyright fields are blank before lending or
transferring the camera to another person. Nikon does not accept
liability for any damages or disputes arising from the use of the
Copyright information option.

B The Setup Menu: Camera Setup 261

Time Zone and Date
G button ➜ B setup menu

Change time zones, synchronize the clock with the clock on a
smart device, set the camera clock, choose the date display
order, and turn daylight saving time on or off.
Option

Description
Choose a time zone. The camera clock is automatically
Time zone
set to the time in the new time zone.
Date and time Set the camera clock (0 40).
Choose whether the camera clock is updated to the
Sync with time (Coordinated Universal Time, or UTC), time zone,
smart device and standard or daylight saving time supplied by the
smart device.
Choose the order in which the day, month, and year
Date format
are displayed.
Daylight
Turn daylight saving time on or off. The camera clock
saving time will automatically be advanced or set back one hour.

Language
G button ➜ B setup menu

Choose a language for camera menus and messages.

262 B The Setup Menu: Camera Setup

Beep Options
G button ➜ B setup menu

Beeps sound when the camera focuses, in self-timer mode, and
when time-lapse recording ends or touch-screen controls are
used.

❚❚ Beep On/Off
Select Off (touch controls only) to mute
the sounds the camera makes in
response to touch-screen controls, or
choose Off to prevent beeps from
sounding altogether.

❚❚ Pitch
Choose the pitch (High or Low) of the sounds made when timelapse recording ends or in response to focus and self-timer
operations.

Touch Controls
G button ➜ B setup menu

Select Disable to prevent accidental use of touch-screen
controls (0 15), or Playback only to enable touch-screen
controls in playback mode only.

Monitor Brightness
G button ➜ B setup menu

Press 1 or 3 to choose monitor brightness. Choose higher
values for increased brightness, lower values for reduced
brightness.

B The Setup Menu: Camera Setup 263

Info Display Format
G button ➜ B setup menu

Choose an information display format (0 6). Formats can be
chosen separately for auto, scene, and special effects modes and
for P, S, A, and M modes.

Classic

1 Select a shooting mode option.
Highlight AUTO/SCENE/EFFECTS or
P/S/A/M and press 2.

2 Select a design.
Highlight a design and press J.

264 B The Setup Menu: Camera Setup

Graphic

Auto Info Display
G button ➜ B setup menu

If On is selected, the information display will appear after the
shutter-release button is pressed halfway. If Off is selected, the
information display can be viewed by pressing the R button.

Info Display Auto Off
G button ➜ B setup menu

If On is selected, the eye sensor will turn the information display
off when you put your eye to the viewfinder. Selecting Off
prevents the display turning off when you look through the
viewfinder, but also increases the drain on the battery.

B The Setup Menu: Camera Setup 265

Image Dust Off Ref Photo
G button ➜ B setup menu

Acquire reference data for the Image Dust Off option in
Capture NX-D (for more information, refer to Capture NX-D
online help).
Image Dust Off ref photo is available only when a CPU lens is
mounted on the camera. A lens with a focal length of at least
50 mm is recommended. When using a zoom lens, zoom all the
way in.

1 Choose a start option.
Highlight one of the following options
and press J. To exit without
acquiring image dust off data, press
G.
• Start: The message shown at right
will be displayed and “rEF” will
appear in the viewfinder.
• Clean sensor and then start: Select this
option to clean the image sensor
before starting. The message shown
at right will be displayed and “rEF”
will appear in the viewfinder when cleaning is complete.
D Image Sensor Cleaning
Dust off reference data recorded before image sensor cleaning is
performed can not be used with photographs taken after image
sensor cleaning is performed. Select Clean sensor and then start
only if the dust off reference data will not be used with existing
photographs.

266 B The Setup Menu: Camera Setup

2 Frame a featureless white object in the viewfinder.
With the lens about ten centimeters (four inches) from a welllit, featureless white object, frame the object so that it fills the
viewfinder and then press the shutter-release button
halfway.
In autofocus mode, focus will automatically be set to infinity;
in manual focus mode, set focus to infinity manually.

3 Acquire Image Dust Off reference data.
Press the shutter-release button the rest of the way down to
acquire Image Dust Off reference data. The monitor turns off
when the shutter-release button is pressed.
If the reference object is too bright or
too dark, the camera may be unable to
acquire Image Dust Off reference data
and the message shown at right will
be displayed. Choose another
reference object and repeat the
process from step 1.
D Image Dust Off Reference Data
The same reference data can be used for
photographs taken with different lenses or
at different apertures. Reference images can
not be viewed using computer imaging
software. A grid pattern is displayed when
reference images are viewed on the camera.

B The Setup Menu: Camera Setup 267

Flicker Reduction
G button ➜ B setup menu

Reduce flicker and banding when shooting under fluorescent or
mercury-vapor lighting during live view (0 55) or movie
recording (0 164). Choose Auto to allow the camera to
automatically choose the correct frequency, or manually match
the frequency to that of the local AC power supply.
A Flicker Reduction
If Auto fails to produce the desired results and you are unsure as to the
frequency of the local power supply, test both the 50 and 60 Hz
options and choose the one that produces the best results. Flicker
reduction may not produce the desired results if the subject is very
bright, in which case you should select mode A or M and choose a
smaller aperture (higher f-number) before starting live view. Note that
flicker reduction is not available when On is selected for Movie
settings > Manual movie settings (0 169) in mode M.

Slot Empty Release Lock
G button ➜ B setup menu

If Release locked is selected, the shutter-release button is only
enabled when a memory card is inserted in the camera.
Selecting Enable release allows the shutter to be released when
no memory card is inserted, although no pictures will be
recorded (they will however be displayed in the monitor in
demo mode).

268 B The Setup Menu: Camera Setup

Location Data
G button ➜ B setup menu

Adjust location data settings for use when the camera is
connected to a GPS or smart device.
Option

Description
Select Yes to download location data from the smart
device and embed them in pictures taken over the next
Download
two hours. If the camera is connected to both a smart
from smart
device and a GPS unit, location data will be downloaded
device
from the GPS unit. Location data can not be acquired if
the camera is off or the standby timer has expired.
View the location data supplied by the GPS or smart
Position device (the items displayed vary with the device and in
the case of movies are for the start of recording).
Adjust settings for connection to optional GPS devices.
• Standby timer: Choose whether the standby timer
remains active while a GPS device is connected. If
Enable is selected, the exposure meters will turn off
automatically if no operations are performed for the
period specified in Custom Setting c2 (Auto off timers,
External
0 240), reducing the drain on the battery. If a GP-1 or
GPS device GP-1A unit is connected, the unit will remain active for a
options
set period after the timer expires; to allow the camera
time to acquire location data, the delay is extended by
up to one minute after exposure meters are activated or
the camera is turned on. Select Disable to disable the
standby timer when a GPS device is connected.
• Set clock from satellite: Select Yes to synchronize the
camera clock with the time reported by the GPS device.

B The Setup Menu: Camera Setup 269

Remote Control
G button ➜ B setup menu

Choose the functions performed using optional remote cords or
wireless remote controllers (0 323, 324).

❚❚ Remote Shutter Release
Choose whether the shutter-release button on the optional
accessory is used for photography or movie recording.
Option
y Take photos

z Record movies

Description
The shutter-release button on the optional
accessory is used to take photographs.
The shutter-release button on the optional
accessory is used for movie recording. Press the
button halfway to start live view or to focus in
AF-S and AF-F modes. Press the button all the
way down to start or end recording. Use the
camera live view switch to end live view.

❚❚ Assign Fn button
Choose the role played by the Fn buttons on wireless remote
controllers.
Option

Description
The Fn button on the wireless remote controller
Same as camera
=4
performs the function currently assigned to the
4 button
camera A (L) button (0 254).
The Fn button on the wireless remote controller
a Live view
can be used to start and end live view.

270 B The Setup Menu: Camera Setup

Airplane Mode
G button ➜ B setup menu

Select Enable to disable the wireless features of Eye-Fi cards and
Bluetooth and Wi-Fi connections to smart devices. Connections
to other devices using a wireless transmitter can only be
disabled by removing the transmitter from the camera.

Connect to Smart Device
G button ➜ B setup menu

Adjust settings for connection to smart
devices.

A Security
Although one of the benefits of this product is that it allows others to
freely connect for the wireless exchange of data anywhere within its
range, the following may occur if security is not enabled:
• Data theft: Malicious third-parties may intercept wireless
transmissions to steal user IDs, passwords, and other personal
information.
• Unauthorized access: Unauthorized users may gain access to the
network and alter data or perform other malicious actions. Note that
due to the design of wireless networks, specialized attacks may allow
unauthorized access even when security is enabled.

B The Setup Menu: Camera Setup 271

Send to Smart Device (Auto)
G button ➜ B setup menu

If On is selected, new photos will automatically be uploaded to
the smart device (if the camera is not currently connected to the
smart device, the photos will be marked for upload and
uploaded the next time a wireless connection is established).
Movies are not uploaded.
A Upload Marking
No more than 1000 photos can be marked for upload at a time.
Before changing the rating of photos that are marked for upload,
select Disable for Bluetooth > Network connection or switch
wireless off by selecting Enable for Airplane mode.

Wi-Fi
G button ➜ B setup menu

Adjust Wi-Fi (wireless LAN) settings.
Option
Description
Network settings Adjust settings for Wi-Fi connections.
Current settings View current Wi-Fi settings.
Reset connection
Restore Wi-Fi settings to their default values.
settings

272 B The Setup Menu: Camera Setup

Bluetooth
G button ➜ B setup menu

List paired devices and adjust settings for connection to smart
devices.
Option
Description
Network
Enable or disable Bluetooth.
connection
Paired devices View paired devices.
Select Off to suspend wireless transmissions when
Send while off
the camera is turned off or the standby timer expires.

B The Setup Menu: Camera Setup 273

Eye-Fi Upload
G button ➜ B setup menu

This option is displayed only when an Eye-Fi memory card
(available separately from third-party suppliers) is inserted in the
camera. Choose Enable to upload photographs to a preselected
destination. Note that pictures will not be uploaded if signal
strength is insufficient. Before uploading pictures via Eye-Fi,
select Disable for Airplane mode (0 271) and Bluetooth >
Network connection (0 273).
Observe all local laws concerning wireless devices and choose
Disable where wireless devices are prohibited.
D Eye-Fi Cards
Eye-Fi cards may emit wireless signals when Disable is selected.
A g icon displayed when Disable is selected indicates that the camera
is unable to control the Eye-Fi card (0 275); turn the camera off and
remove the card.
Select longer values for Custom Setting c2 (Auto off timers) >
Custom > Standby timer (0 240) when using an Eye-Fi card.
See the manual provided with the Eye-Fi card, and direct any inquiries
to the manufacturer. The camera can be used to turn Eye-Fi cards on
and off, but may not support other Eye-Fi functions.

D Airplane Mode (0 271)
Enabling airplane mode disables Eye-Fi upload. To resume Eye-Fi
upload, select Disable for Airplane mode before selecting Enable for
Eye-Fi upload.

274 B The Setup Menu: Camera Setup

When an Eye-Fi card is inserted, its status
is indicated by an icon in the information
display:
• d: Eye-Fi upload disabled.
• e: Eye-Fi upload enabled but no
pictures available for upload.
• f (static): Eye-Fi upload enabled;
waiting to begin upload.
• f (animated): Eye-Fi upload enabled; uploading data.
• g: Error — camera can not control Eye-Fi card. If a flashing (
appears in the viewfinder, check that the Eye-Fi card firmware
is up-to-date; if the error persists after the card firmware has
been updated, insert a different card or format the card in the
camera after copying any pictures it contains to a computer or
other storage device. If the ( indicator is not flashing,
pictures can be taken normally but you may be unable to
change Eye-Fi settings.
A Supported Eye-Fi Cards
Some cards may not be available in some countries or regions; consult
the manufacturer for more information. Eye-Fi cards are for use only in
the country of purchase. Be sure the Eye-Fi card firmware has been
updated to the latest version.

B The Setup Menu: Camera Setup 275

Conformity Marking
G button ➜ B setup menu

View a selection of the standards with which the camera
complies.

Firmware Version
G button ➜ B setup menu

View the current camera firmware version.

276 B The Setup Menu: Camera Setup

N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies
To display the retouch menu, press G and select the N
(retouch menu) tab.

G button

Retouch Menu Options
The options in the retouch menu are used to create trimmed or
retouched copies of existing pictures. The retouch menu is only
displayed when a memory card containing photographs is
inserted in the camera.

0
k
1
i
2
j
e
(
r
)
m

Option
NEF (RAW)
processing
Trim
Resize
D-Lighting
Quick retouch
Red-eye correction
Straighten
Distortion control
Perspective control
Fisheye
Filter effects

0
280
282
283
285
286
286
287
287
288
288
289

Option
Monochrome
Image overlay
Color outline
Photo illustration
Color sketch
Miniature effect
Selective color
Painting
Edit movie
Side-by-side
p
comparison *
l
o
q
U
g
u
3
)
f

0
290
291
293
294
294
295
296
298
178
298

* Available only if retouch menu is displayed by pressing P and selecting Retouch when a
retouched image or original is displayed in full-frame playback.

N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies 277

Creating Retouched Copies
To create a retouched copy:

1 Display retouch options.
Highlight the desired item in the
retouch menu and press 2.

2 Select a picture.
Highlight a picture and press J (to
view the highlighted picture full
screen, press and hold the X button).

A Retouch
The camera may not be able to display or retouch images created
with other devices. If the image was recorded at image quality
settings of NEF (RAW) + JPEG (0 98), retouch options apply only to
the RAW copy.

3 Select retouch options.
For more information, see the section for the selected item.
To exit without creating a retouched copy, press G.

278 N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies

4 Create a retouched copy.
Press J to create a retouched copy.
Except in the photo information
“image only” page (0 188),
retouched copies are indicated by a Z
icon.
A Creating Retouched Copies During Playback
To create a retouched copy of the picture currently displayed in fullframe playback (0 184), press P, then highlight Retouch and press 2
and select a retouch option (Image overlay excluded).

A Retouching Copies
Most options can be applied to copies created using other retouch
options, although with the exceptions of Image overlay and Edit
movie > Choose start/end point, each option can be applied only
once (note that multiple edits may result in loss of detail). Options that
can not be applied to the current image are grayed out and
unavailable.

A Image Quality and Size
Except in the case of copies created with Trim and Resize, copies
created from JPEG images are the same size and quality as the original,
while copies created from NEF (RAW) photos are saved as large finequality JPEG images.

N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies 279

NEF (RAW) Processing
G button ➜ N retouch menu

Create JPEG copies of NEF (RAW) photographs.

1 Select NEF (RAW) processing.
Highlight NEF (RAW) processing in
the retouch menu and press 2 to
display a picture selection dialog
listing only NEF (RAW) images created
with this camera.

2 Select a photograph.
Use the multi selector to highlight a
photograph (to view the highlighted
photograph full frame, press and hold
the X button). Press J to select the
highlighted photograph and proceed
to the next step.

280 N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies

3 Choose settings for the JPEG copy.
Adjust the settings listed below. Note that white balance and
vignette control are not available with pictures created with
image overlay (0 291), and that the effects of exposure
compensation may differ from those that might have been
expected when the photograph was taken.
Image quality (0 98)
Image size (0 100)
White balance (0 140)
Exposure compensation (0 132)
Picture Control (0 155)
High ISO NR (0 231)
Color space (0 230)
Vignette control (0 231)
D-Lighting (0 285)

4 Copy the photograph.
Highlight EXE and press J to create a
JPEG copy of the selected
photograph. To exit without copying
the photograph, press the G
button.

N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies 281

Trim
G button ➜ N retouch menu

Create a cropped copy of the selected
photograph. The selected photograph is
displayed with the selected crop shown
in yellow; create a cropped copy as
described in the following table.
To
Increase size of
crop
Reduce size of
crop

Use

Description
Press the X button to increase the size of the
X
crop.
Press the W (Q) button to reduce the size of
W (Q)
the crop.

Change crop
aspect ratio

Rotate the command dial to choose the
aspect ratio.

Move crop

Use multi selector to position the crop. Press
and hold to move the crop rapidly to the
desired position.

Create copy

Save the current crop as a separate file.

A Image Size
The size of the copy (which varies with crop size and aspect ratio)
appears at upper left in the crop display.

A Viewing Cropped Copies
Playback zoom may not be available when cropped copies are
displayed.

A See Also
See page 198 for information on cropping pictures during playback
zoom.

282 N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies

Resize
G button ➜ N retouch menu

Create small copies of selected photographs.

1 Select Resize.
To resize selected images, highlight
Resize in the retouch menu and press
2.

2 Choose a size.
Highlight Choose size and press 2.

Highlight an option and press J.

N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies 283

3 Choose pictures.
Highlight Select image and press 2.

Highlight pictures using the multi
selector and press the W (Q) button
to select or deselect (to view the
highlighted picture full screen, press
and hold the X button). Selected
pictures are marked by a 1 icon.
Press J when the selection is
complete.

W (Q) button

4 Save the resized copies.
A confirmation dialog will be
displayed. Highlight Yes and press J
to save the resized copies.

A Viewing Resized Copies
Playback zoom may not be available when resized copies are
displayed.

284 N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies

D-Lighting
G button ➜ N retouch menu

D-Lighting brightens shadows, making it ideal for dark or backlit
photographs.

Before

D-Lighting
(U Portrait disabled)

D-Lighting
(M Portrait enabled)

Press 4 or 2 to choose the amount of correction performed; the
effect can be previewed in the edit display. Press J to copy the
photograph.

❚❚ “Portrait”
To enable or disable this option,
highlight Portrait and press 2. When
Portrait is enabled, the camera will apply
D-Lighting only to human portrait
subjects, brightening up to three such
subjects while leaving the background
untouched for an effect similar to that achieved with a reflector.
A Portrait Subjects
The camera automatically selects up to three subjects for portrait
D-Lighting (note that portrait D-Lighting can not be applied to photos
taken with Off selected for Auto image rotation in the playback
menu; 0 222). Depending on composition and how the subjects are
posed, the desired results may not be achieved; if you are not satisfied,
remove the check from Portrait.

N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies 285

Quick Retouch
G button ➜ N retouch menu

Create copies with enhanced saturation
and contrast. D-Lighting is applied as
required to brighten dark or backlit
subjects.
Press 4 or 2 to choose the amount of
enhancement. Press J to copy the
photograph.

Red-Eye Correction
G button ➜ N retouch menu

This option is used to correct “red-eye” caused by the flash, and
is available only with photographs taken using the flash. The
photograph selected for red-eye correction can be previewed in
the edit display. Confirm the effects of red-eye correction and
press J to create a copy. Note that red-eye correction may not
always produce the expected results and may in very rare
circumstances be applied to portions of the image that are not
affected by red-eye; check the preview thoroughly before
proceeding.

286 N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies

Straighten
G button ➜ N retouch menu

Create a straightened copy of the
selected image. Press 2 to rotate the
image clockwise by up to five degrees in
increments of approximately 0.25
degrees, 4 to rotate it counterclockwise
(note that edges of the image will be
trimmed to create a rectangular copy). Press J to save the
retouched copy.

Distortion Control
G button ➜ N retouch menu

Create copies with reduced peripheral
distortion. Select Auto to let the camera
correct distortion automatically and then
make fine adjustments using the multi
selector, or select Manual to reduce
distortion manually (note that Auto is
not available with photos taken using auto distortion control;
see page 232).
Press 2 to reduce barrel distortion, 4 to reduce pin-cushion
distortion (note that greater amounts of distortion control result
in more of the edges being cropped out). Press J to save the
retouched copy.
D Auto
Auto is for use only with pictures taken with type G, E, and D lenses
(PC, fisheye, and certain other lenses excluded); results are not
guaranteed with other lenses.

N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies 287

Perspective Control
G button ➜ N retouch menu

Create copies that reduce the effects of
perspective taken from the base of a tall
object. Use the multi selector to adjust
perspective (note that greater amounts
of perspective control result in more of
the edges being cropped out). Press J
to save the retouched copy.

Before

After

Fisheye
G button ➜ N retouch menu

Create copies that appear to have been
taken with a fisheye lens. Press 2 to
increase the effect (this also increases the
amount that will be cropped out at the
edges of the image), 4 to reduce it. Press
J to save the retouched copy.

288 N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies

Filter Effects
G button ➜ N retouch menu

After adjusting filter effects as described below, press J to copy
the photograph.
Option
Skylight

Warm filter

Cross screen

Soft

Description
Creates the effect of a
skylight filter, making the
picture less blue.
Creates a copy with warm
tone filter effects, giving the
copy a “warm” red cast.
Add starburst effects to light
sources.
• Number of points: Choose
from four, six, or eight.
• Filter amount: Choose the
brightness of the light
sources affected.
• Filter angle: Choose the angle of the points.
• Length of points: Choose the length of points.
• Confirm: Preview the effects of the filter. Press X to
preview the copy full frame.
• Save: Create a retouched copy.
Add a soft filter effect. Press
4 or 2 to choose the filter
strength.

N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies 289

Monochrome
G button ➜ N retouch menu

Copy photographs in Black-and-white,
Sepia, or Cyanotype (blue and white
monochrome).

Selecting Sepia or Cyanotype displays a
preview of the selected image; press 1
to increase color saturation, 3 to
decrease. Press J to create a
monochrome copy.
Increase saturation

Decrease saturation

290 N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies

Image Overlay
G button ➜ N retouch menu

Image overlay combines two existing NEF (RAW) photographs to
create a single picture that is saved separately from the originals;
the results, which make use of RAW data from the camera image
sensor, are noticeably better than overlays created in an imaging
application. The new picture is saved at current image quality
and size settings; before creating an overlay, set image quality
and size (0 98, 100; all options are available). To create an NEF
(RAW) copy, choose an image quality of NEF (RAW).

+

1 Select Image overlay.
Highlight Image overlay in the
retouch menu and press 2.

The dialog shown at right will be
displayed, with Image 1 highlighted;
press J to display a list of the NEF
(RAW) pictures created with this
camera.

N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies 291

2 Select the first image.
Use the multi selector to highlight the
first photograph in the overlay. To
view the highlighted photograph full
frame, press and hold the X button.
Press J to select the highlighted
photograph and return to the preview display.

3 Select the second image.
The selected image will appear as Image 1. Highlight
Image 2 and press J, then select the second photo as
described in Step 2.

4 Adjust gain.
Highlight Image 1 or Image 2 and
optimize exposure for the overlay by
pressing 1 or 3 to select gain from
values between 0.1 and 2.0. Repeat
for the second image. The default
value is 1.0; select 0.5 to halve gain or 2.0 to double it. The
effects of gain are visible in the Preview column.

5 Preview the overlay.
To preview the composition as shown
at right, press 4 or 2 to place the
cursor in the Preview column, then
press 1 or 3 to highlight Overlay
and press J (note that colors and
brightness in the preview may differ from the final image). To
save the overlay without displaying a preview, select Save. To
return to Step 4 and select new photos or adjust gain, press
W (Q).

292 N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies

6 Save the overlay.
Press J while the preview is
displayed to save the overlay. After an
overlay is created, the resulting image
will be displayed full-frame in the
monitor.
D Image Overlay
Only NEF (RAW) photographs with the same bit depth can be
combined (0 227). The overlay has the same photo info as the
photograph selected for Image 1. The current image comment is
appended to the overlay when it is saved; copyright information,
however, is not copied.

Color Outline
G button ➜ N retouch menu

Create an outline copy of a photograph
to use as a base for painting. Press J to
save the retouched copy.

Before

After

N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies 293

Photo Illustration
G button ➜ N retouch menu

Sharpen outlines and simplify coloring
for a poster effect. Press 2 or 4 to make
outlines thicker or thinner. Press J to
save the retouched copy.

Before

After

Color Sketch
G button ➜ N retouch menu

Create a copy of a photograph that
resembles a sketch made with colored
pencils. Press 1 or 3 to highlight
Vividness or Outlines and press 4 or 2
to change. Vividness can be increased to
make colors more saturated, or
decreased for a washed-out,
monochromatic effect, while outlines can be made thicker or
thinner. Thicker outlines make colors more saturated. Press J
to save the retouched copy.

294 N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies

Miniature Effect
G button ➜ N retouch menu

Create a copy that appears to be a photo of a diorama. Works
best with photos taken from a high vantage point. The area that
will be in focus in the copy is indicated by a yellow frame.
To
Choose
orientation

Choose area
in focus

Press

Description
Press W (Q) to choose orientation of area that is
W (Q)
in focus.
If area of effect is in
wide orientation, press
1 or 3 to position
frame showing area of
copy that will be in
focus.
Area in focus
If area of effect is in tall
orientation, press 4 or
2 to position frame
showing area of copy
that will be in focus.
If area of effect is in wide orientation, press 4 or
2 to choose height.

Choose size
If area of effect is in tall orientation, press 1 or
3 to choose width.
Create copy

Create copy.

N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies 295

Selective Color
G button ➜ N retouch menu

Create a copy in which only selected hues appear in color.

1 Select Selective color.
Highlight Selective color in the
retouch menu and press 2.

2 Select a photograph.
Highlight a photograph and press J
(to view the highlighted photograph
full frame, press and hold the X
button).

3 Select a color.
Use the multi selector to position the
cursor over an object and press A
(L) to select the color of the object
as one that will remain in the final
copy (the camera may have difficulty
A (L) button
detecting unsaturated colors; choose
a saturated color). To zoom in on the Selected color
picture for precise color selection,
press X. Press W (Q) to zoom out.

296 N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies

4 Highlight the color range.

Color range

Rotate the command dial to
highlight the color range for
the selected color.

5 Choose the color range.
Press 1 or 3 to increase or decrease
the range of similar hues that will be
included in the final photograph.
Choose from values between 1 and 7;
note that higher values may include
hues from other colors.

6 Select additional colors.
To select additional colors,
rotate the command dial to
highlight another of the
three color boxes at the top
of the display and repeat
Steps 3–5 to select another color. Repeat for a third color if
desired. To deselect the highlighted color, press O (to remove
all colors, press and hold O. A confirmation dialog will be
displayed; select Yes).

7 Save the edited copy.
Press J to copy the photograph.

N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies 297

Painting
G button ➜ N retouch menu

Create a copy which emphasizes detail
and color for a painterly effect. Press J
to save the retouched copy.

Before

After

Side-by-side Comparison
Compare retouched copies to the original photographs. This
option is only available if the retouch menu is displayed by
pressing the P button and selecting Retouch when a copy or
original is played back full frame.

1 Select a picture.
Select a retouched copy (shown by a
Z icon) or a photograph that has
been retouched in full-frame
playback. Press P, then highlight
Retouch and press 2.

298 N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies

P button

2 Select Side-by-side comparison.
Highlight Side-by-side comparison
in the retouch menu and press J.

3 Compare the copy with the original.

Options used to create

The source image is displayed on the
copy
left, the retouched copy on the right,
with the options used to create the
copy listed at the top of the display.
Press 4 or 2 to switch between the
source image and the retouched copy.
To view the highlighted picture full
Source
Retouched
frame, press and hold the X button. If
image
copy
the copy was created from two
images using Image overlay, press 1
or 3 to view the other source image. If multiple copies exist
for the current source image, press 1 or 3 to view the other
copies. Press J to return to playback with the highlighted
image displayed.
D Side-by-side comparison
The source image will not be displayed if the copy was created from a
photograph that has since been deleted or that was protected when
the copy was made (0 200).

N The Retouch Menu: Creating Retouched Copies 299

m Recent Settings/O My Menu
Both recent settings, a menu listing the 20 most recently used
settings, and My Menu, a custom menu listing up to 20 userselected options, can be accessed by pressing the G button
highlighting the last tab in the menu list (either m or O).

G button

Choosing a Menu
Use the Choose tab option to choose the menu displayed.

1 Select Choose tab.
Highlight Choose tab and press 2.

2 Select a menu.
Highlight O MY MENU or m RECENT
SETTINGS and press J to display the
selected menu.

300 m Recent Settings/O My Menu

m Recent Settings
When m RECENT SETTINGS is selected
for Choose tab, the menu lists the 20
most recently used settings, with the
most recently-used items first. Press 1 or
3 to highlight an option and press 2 to
select.
A Removing Items from the Recent Settings Menu
To remove an item from the recent settings menu, highlight it and
press the O button. A confirmation dialog will be displayed; press O
again to delete the selected item.

O My Menu
Selecting O MY MENU for Choose tab lets you access a
customized menu of up to 20 options selected from the
playback, shooting, Custom Settings, setup, and retouch menus.
Follow the steps below to add items to, delete items from, and
reorder items in My Menu.

❚❚ Adding Options to My Menu

1 Select Add items.
Highlight Add items and press 2.

2 Select a menu.
Highlight the name of the menu
containing the option you wish to add
and press 2.

m Recent Settings/O My Menu 301

3 Select an item.
Highlight the desired menu item and
press J.

4 Position the new item.
Press 1 or 3 to move the new item up
or down in My Menu. Press J to add
the new item. Repeat steps 1–4 to
select additional items.
A Adding Options to My Menu
The items currently displayed in My Menu
are indicated by a check mark. Items
indicated by a V icon can not be selected.

302 m Recent Settings/O My Menu

❚❚ Deleting Options from My Menu

1 Select Remove items.
Highlight Remove items and press 2.

2 Select items.
Highlight items and press 2 to select
or deselect. Selected items are
indicated by a check mark.

3 Delete the selected items.
Press J. A confirmation dialog will be
displayed; press J again to delete the
selected items.

m Recent Settings/O My Menu 303

❚❚ Reordering Options in My Menu

1 Select Rank items.
Highlight Rank items and press 2.

2 Select an item.
Highlight the item you wish to move
and press J.

3 Position the item.
Press 1 or 3 to move the item up or
down in My Menu and press J.
Repeat Steps 2–3 to reposition
additional items.

4 Exit to My Menu.
Press the G button to return to My
Menu.

G button

304 m Recent Settings/O My Menu

Technical Notes
Read this chapter for information on compatible accessories,
cleaning and storing the camera, and what to do if an error
message is displayed or you encounter problems using the
camera.

Compatible Lenses
Compatible CPU Lenses
This camera supports autofocus with AF-S, AF-P, and AF-I CPU
lenses only. AF-S lenses have names beginning with AF-S, AF-P
lenses with AF-P, and AF-I lenses with AF-I. Autofocus is not
supported with other autofocus (AF) lenses. The following table
lists the features available with compatible lenses in viewfinder
photography:
Camera setting

Focus mode
MF (with
electronic
rangefinder)
z
z
z4
z4
z4
z7

Lens/accessory
AF
MF
AF-S, AF-P, AF-I NIKKOR
z
z
Other type G or D AF NIKKOR —
z
PC-E NIKKOR series 2, 3
—
z
PC NIKKOR 19mm f/4E ED 3, 5 —
z
PC Micro 85mm f/2.8D 6
—
z
AF-S/AF-I teleconverter
z7
z
Other AF NIKKOR (except
8
z
—
z
lenses for F3AF)
AI-P NIKKOR
—
z9
z
1 Spot metering meters selected focus point (0 128).

Shooting
mode

Metering system
L

M
N
3D Color
z — z1
z — z1
z — z1
z — z1
z — z1
z — z1

M
z
z
z
z
z
z

Other
modes
z
z
z
z
—
z

z

z

—

✔

z1

z

z

—

✔

z1

Technical Notes 305

2 The shift knob for the PC-E NIKKOR 24mm f/3.5D ED may contact the camera body when the
lens is rotated. In addition, some combinations of shift and rotation may not be available due
to the lens contacting the camera body.
3 Shifting and/or tilting the lens interferes with exposure.
4 Can not be used with shifting or tilting.
5 Some combinations of shift and rotation may not be available due to the lens contacting the
camera body.
6 Optimal exposure will only be achieved if the lens is at maximum aperture and the lens is not
shifted or tilted.
7 With maximum effective aperture of f/5.6 or faster.
8 When AF 80–200mm f/2.8, AF 35–70mm f/2.8, AF 28–85mm f/3.5–4.5 (New), or
AF 28–85mm f/3.5–4.5 lenses are zoomed all the way in at the minimum focus distance, the
in-focus indicator (I) may be displayed when the image on the matte screen in the
viewfinder is not in focus. Before shooting, confirm that the image in the viewfinder screen is
in focus.
9 With maximum aperture of f/5.6 or faster.
• Noise in the form of lines may appear during autofocus when movies
are recorded at high ISO sensitivities. Use manual focus or focus lock.

306 Technical Notes

D IX NIKKOR Lenses
IX NIKKOR lenses can not be used.

A Identifying CPU and Type G, E, and D Lenses
CPU lenses can be identified by the presence of CPU contacts, type G,
E, and D lenses by a letter on the lens barrel. Type G and E lenses are
not equipped with a lens aperture ring.
CPU contacts

Aperture ring

CPU lens
Type G or E lens
Type D lens
When using a CPU lens equipped with an aperture ring, lock the
aperture ring at the minimum aperture (highest f-number).

A Matrix Metering
For matrix metering, the camera uses a 2016-pixel RGB sensor to set
exposure according to tone distribution, color, composition, and, with
type G, E, or D lenses, distance information (3D color matrix metering
II; with other CPU lenses, the camera uses color matrix metering II;
which does not include 3D distance information).

Technical Notes 307

Compatible Non-CPU Lenses
Non-CPU lenses may only be used when the camera is in mode
M. Selecting another mode disables the shutter release.
Aperture must be adjusted manually via the lens aperture ring
and the camera metering system, i-TTL flash control, and other
features requiring a CPU lens can not be used. Some non-CPU
lenses can not be used; see “Incompatible Accessories and
Non-CPU Lenses,” below.
Camera setting

Focus mode
MF (with
electronic
rangefinder)

Shooting mode

Other
modes
Lens/accessory
AF
MF
M
AI-, AI-modified NIKKOR or Nikon
z
z2
—
—
z1
Series E lenses
2,
3
—
Medical NIKKOR 120mm f/4
—
z
z
z
—
Reflex NIKKOR
—
—
z
z2
z
z2
—
PC NIKKOR
—
z4
AI-type Teleconverter
—
z5
z
z2
—
PB-6 Bellows Focusing
1
2
—
z
z
z
—
Attachment 6
Auto extension rings (PK-series
z
z2
—
—
z1
11A, 12, or 13; PN-11)
1 With maximum aperture of f/5.6 or faster.
2 Exposure indicator can not be used.
3 Can be used at shutter speeds slower than flash sync speed by one step or more.
4 Can not be used with shifting or tilting.
5 With maximum effective aperture of f/5.6 or faster.
6 Attach in vertical orientation (can be used in horizontal orientation once attached).

308 Technical Notes

D Incompatible Accessories and Non-CPU Lenses
The following accessories and non-CPU lenses can NOT be used with
the D5600:
• TC-16A AF teleconverter
• Non-AI lenses
• Lenses that require the AU-1 focusing unit (400mm f/4.5,
600mm f/5.6, 800mm f/8, 1200mm f/11)
• Fisheye (6mm f/5.6, 7.5mm f/5.6, 8mm f/8, OP 10mm f/5.6)
• 2.1cm f/4
• Extension Ring K2
• 180–600mm f/8 ED (serial numbers 174041–174180)
• 360–1200mm f/11 ED (serial numbers 174031–174127)
• 200–600mm f/9.5 (serial numbers 280001–300490)
• AF lenses for the F3AF (AF 80mm f/2.8, AF 200mm f/3.5 ED,
AF Teleconverter TC-16)
• PC 28mm f/4 (serial number 180900 or earlier)
• PC 35mm f/2.8 (serial numbers 851001–906200)
• PC 35mm f/3.5 (old type)
• Reflex 1000mm f/6.3 (old type)
• Reflex 1000mm f/11 (serial numbers 142361–143000)
• Reflex 2000mm f/11 (serial numbers 200111–200310)

Technical Notes 309

D AF-Assist Illumination
The AF-assist illuminator has a range of about 0.5–3.0 m (1 ft 8 in.–9 ft
10 in.); when using the illuminator, use a lens with a focal length of
18–200 mm and remove the lens hood. AF-assist illumination is not
available with the following lenses:
• AF-S NIKKOR 14–24mm f/2.8G ED
• AF-S NIKKOR 28–300mm f/3.5–5.6G ED VR
• AF-S DX NIKKOR 55–300mm f/4.5–5.6G ED VR
• AF-S VR Zoom-Nikkor 70–200mm f/2.8G IF-ED
• AF-S NIKKOR 70–200mm f/2.8G ED VR II
• AF-S Zoom-Nikkor 80–200mm f/2.8D IF-ED
• AF-S NIKKOR 80–400mm f/4.5–5.6G ED VR
• AF-S VR Nikkor 200mm f/2G IF-ED
• AF-S NIKKOR 200mm f/2G ED VR II
• AF-S VR Zoom-Nikkor 200–400mm f/4G IF-ED
• AF-S NIKKOR 200–400mm f/4G ED VR II

310 Technical Notes

At ranges under 1 m (3 ft 3 in.), the following lenses may block the
AF-assist illuminator and interfere with autofocus when lighting is
poor:
• AF-S DX NIKKOR 10–24mm f/3.5–4.5G ED
• AF-S NIKKOR 16–35mm f/4G ED VR
• AF-S Zoom-Nikkor 17–35mm f/2.8D IF-ED
• AF-S DX Zoom-Nikkor 17–55mm f/2.8G IF-ED
• AF-S NIKKOR 18–35mm f/3.5–4.5G ED
• AF-S DX NIKKOR 18–105mm f/3.5–5.6G ED VR
• AF-S DX VR Zoom-Nikkor 18–200mm f/3.5–5.6G IF-ED
• AF-S DX NIKKOR 18–200mm f/3.5–5.6G ED VR II
• AF-S DX NIKKOR 18–300mm f/3.5–5.6G ED VR
• AF-S DX NIKKOR 18–300mm f/3.5–6.3G ED VR
• AF-S NIKKOR 20mm f/1.8G ED
• AF-S NIKKOR 24–70mm f/2.8G ED
• AF-S VR Zoom-Nikkor 24–120mm f/3.5–5.6G IF-ED
• AF-S NIKKOR 24–120mm f/4G ED VR
• AF-S NIKKOR 28mm f/1.8G
• AF-S Zoom-Nikkor 28–70mm f/2.8D IF-ED
• AF-S NIKKOR 35mm f/1.4G
• AF-S NIKKOR 70–200mm f/4G ED
• AF-S NIKKOR 70–200mm f/4G ED VR
• AF-S NIKKOR 85mm f/1.4G
• AF-S NIKKOR 85mm f/1.8G
• AF-S VR Micro-Nikkor 105mm f/2.8G IF-ED

Technical Notes 311

D The Built-in Flash
The built-in flash can be used with lenses with focal lengths of
18–300 mm, although in some cases the flash may be unable to
entirely light the subject at some ranges or focal lengths due to
shadows cast by the lens (see the illustration below), while lenses that
block the subject’s view of the red-eye reduction lamp may interfere
with red-eye reduction. Remove lens hoods to prevent shadows.

Shadow

Vignetting

The flash has a minimum range of about 0.6 m and can not be used in
the macro range of macro zoom lenses. The flash may be unable to
light the entire subject with the following lenses at ranges less than
those given below:
Lens
AF-S DX NIKKOR 10–24mm f/3.5–4.5G ED
AF-S DX Zoom-Nikkor 12–24mm f/4G IF-ED
AF-S NIKKOR 16–35mm f/4G ED VR
AF-S DX NIKKOR 16–85mm f/3.5–5.6G ED VR
AF-S Zoom-Nikkor 17–35mm f/2.8D IF-ED
AF-S DX Zoom-Nikkor 17–55mm f/2.8G IF-ED

AF-S NIKKOR 18–35mm f/3.5–4.5G ED
AF Zoom-Nikkor 18–35mm f/3.5–4.5D IF-ED

312 Technical Notes

Zoom
Minimum distance
position without vignetting
24 mm
1.5 m/ 4 ft 12 in.
24 mm
1.0 m/ 3 ft 4 in.
35 mm
1.0 m/ 3 ft 4 in.
24–85 mm
No vignetting
28 mm
1.0 m/ 3 ft 4 in.
35 mm
No vignetting
28 mm
1.5 m/ 4 ft 12 in.
35 mm
1.0 m/ 3 ft 4 in.
45–55 mm
No vignetting
24 mm
1.5 m/ 4 ft 12 in.
28 mm
1.0 m/ 3 ft 4 in.
35 mm
No vignetting
24 mm
1.0 m/ 3 ft 4 in.
28–35 mm
No vignetting

Zoom
Minimum distance
position without vignetting
18 mm
1.0 m/ 3 ft 4 in.
24–55 mm
No vignetting
18 mm
1.0 m/ 3 ft 4 in.
AF-S DX Zoom-Nikkor 18–70mm f/3.5–4.5G IF-ED
24–70 mm
No vignetting
18 mm
2.5 m/ 8 ft 3 in.
AF-S DX NIKKOR 18–105mm f/3.5–5.6G ED VR
24 mm
1.0 m/ 3 ft 4 in.
35–105 mm
No vignetting
18 mm
2.0 m/ 6 ft 7 in.
AF-S DX Zoom-Nikkor 18–135mm f/3.5–5.6G IF-ED
24–135 mm
No vignetting
18 mm
1.0 m/ 3 ft 4 in.
AF-S DX NIKKOR 18–140mm f/3.5–5.6G ED VR
24 mm
35–140 mm
No vignetting
24 mm
1.0 m/ 3 ft 4 in.
AF-S DX VR Zoom-Nikkor 18–200mm f/3.5–5.6G IF-ED,
AF-S DX NIKKOR 18–200mm f/3.5–5.6G ED VR II
35–200 mm
No vignetting
AF-S DX NIKKOR 18–300mm f/3.5–5.6G ED VR
35–300 mm 1.0 m/ 3 ft 4 in.
AF-S DX NIKKOR 18–300mm f/3.5–6.3G ED VR
35–300 mm
No vignetting
AF-S NIKKOR 20mm f/1.8G ED
20 mm
1.5 m/ 4 ft 12 in.
24 mm
2.5 m/ 8 ft 3 in.
AF Zoom-Nikkor 20–35mm f/2.8D IF
28 mm
1.0 m/ 3 ft 4 in.
35 mm
No vignetting
AF-S NIKKOR 24mm f/1.4G ED
24 mm
1.0 m/ 3 ft 4 in.
35 mm
1.5 m/ 4 ft 12 in.
AF-S NIKKOR 24–70mm f/2.8G ED
50–70 mm
No vignetting
24 mm
1.0 m/ 3 ft 4 in.
AF-S VR Zoom-Nikkor 24–120mm f/3.5–5.6G IF-ED
28–120 mm
No vignetting
24 mm
1.5 m/ 4 ft 12 in.
AF-S NIKKOR 24–120mm f/4G ED VR
28–120 mm
No vignetting
35 mm
1.5 m/ 4 ft 12 in.
AF-S Zoom-Nikkor 28–70mm f/2.8D IF-ED
50–70 mm
No vignetting
28 mm
1.5 m/ 4 ft 12 in.
AF-S NIKKOR 28–300mm f/3.5–5.6G ED VR
35 mm
1.0 m/ 3 ft 4 in.
50–300 mm
No vignetting
Lens
AF-P DX NIKKOR 18–55mm f/3.5–5.6G VR,
AF-P DX NIKKOR 18–55mm f/3.5–5.6G

Technical Notes 313

Lens
AF-S VR Zoom-Nikkor 200–400mm f/4G IF-ED,
AF-S NIKKOR 200–400mm f/4G ED VR II
PC-E NIKKOR 24mm f/3.5D ED *
* When not shifted or tilted.

Zoom
position
200 mm
250 mm
300 mm
24 mm

Minimum distance
without vignetting
4.0 m/13 ft 2 in.
3.0 m/ 9 ft 11 in.
2.5 m/ 8 ft 3 in.
3.0 m/ 9 ft 11 in.

When used with the AF-S NIKKOR 14–24mm f/2.8G ED, the flash will be
unable to light the entire subject at all ranges.

A Calculating Angle of View
The size of the area exposed by a 35mm camera is 36 × 24 mm. The
size of the area exposed by the D5600, in contrast, is 23.5 × 15.6 mm,
meaning that the angle of view of a 35mm camera is approximately 1.5
times that of the D5600. The approximate focal length of lenses for the
D5600 in 35mm format can be calculated by multiplying the focal
length of the lens by about 1.5.
Picture size (35mm format)
(36 × 24 mm)
Lens

Picture diagonal
Picture size (D5600)
(23.5 × 15.6 mm)
Angle of view (35mm format)
Angle of view (D5600)

314 Technical Notes

The Nikon Creative Lighting System (CLS)
Nikon’s advanced Creative Lighting System (CLS) offers
improved communication between the camera and compatible
flash units for improved flash photography. The built-in flash will
not fire when an optional flash unit is attached.

❚❚ CLS-Compatible Flash Units
The following features are available with CLS-compatible flash
units:

SB-300

SB-400

SB-R200

SB-500

SU-800

z

SB-600

SB-700
SB-910, SB-900,
SB-800
SB-5000

Single flash
Master
Optical Advanced
Wireless Lighting

i-TTL balanced fillflash for digital SLR 1
i-TTL
Standard i-TTL fillflash for digital SLR
%A Auto aperture
A Non-TTL auto
Distance-priority
GN
manual
M Manual
RPT Repeating flash
Remote flash control
i-TTL i-TTL
Quick wireless flash
[A:B]
control
%A Auto aperture
A Non-TTL auto
M Manual
RPT Repeating flash

z

z z z — — z z

z2 z2

z z2 z — — z z

z z3 — — — — — — —
—4 z3 — — — — — — —
z

z

z — — — — — —

z
z
z
z

z
z
z
z

z
—
z
z

z

—

z — — z6 — — —

z
—
—
—

z5
—
z5
z5

—
—
z
—

z z7 — — — —
— z — — — —
z z z — z5 —
z z — — — —

—
—
—
—

—
—
—
—

z5
—
—
—

—
—
—
—

z5
—
—
—

—
—
—
—

Technical Notes 315

SB-300

SB-400

SU-800

SB-R200

SB-500

SB-600

SB-700
SB-910, SB-900,
SB-800
SB-5000

Remote
Optical Advanced
Wireless Lighting

i-TTL i-TTL
z z z z z — z — —
Quick wireless flash
[A:B]
z z z z z — z — —
control
Auto aperture/
%A/A
z8 z7 — — — — — — —
Non-TTL auto
M Manual
z z z z z — z — —
RPT Repeating flash
z z z z z — — — —
Radio-controlled Advanced Wireless Lighting — — — — — — — — —
Color Information Communication (flash)
z z z z z — — z z
Color Information Communication (LED light) — — — — z — — — —
AF-assist for multi-area AF
z z z z — z9 — — —
Red-eye reduction
z z z z z — — z —
Camera flash mode selection
— — — — z — — z z
Camera flash unit firmware update
z z 10 z — z — — — z
1 Not available with spot metering.
2 Can also be selected with flash unit.
3 %A/A mode selection performed on flash unit using custom settings. “A” will be selected
when a non-CPU lens is used.
4 “A” will be selected when a non-CPU lens is used.
5 Can only be selected with camera (0 246).
6 Available only during close-up photography.
7 “A” is used with non-CPU lenses, regardless of mode selected with flash unit.
8 Choice of %A and A depends on the option selected with master flash.
9 Available only in commander mode.
10 Firmware updates for the SB-910 and SB-900 can be performed from the camera.

The SU-800 wireless speedlight commander: When mounted on a CLScompatible camera, the SU-800 can be used as a commander for
SB-5000, SB-910, SB-900, SB-800, SB-700, SB-600, SB-500, or
SB-R200 flash units in up to three groups. The SU-800 itself is not
equipped with a flash.
316 Technical Notes

❚❚ Other Flash Units
The following flash units can be used in non-TTL auto and
manual modes. Use with the camera in exposure mode S or M
and a shutter speed of 1/200 s or slower selected.
SB-80DX,
SB-30, SB-27 2,
SB-23,
SB-28DX,
SB-22S, SB-22, SB-29 3,
SB-28, SB-26,
SB-20, SB-16B, SB-21B 3,
SB-25, SB-24 SB-50DX 1
SB-15
SB-29S 3
Flash mode
A Non-TTL auto
z
—
z
—
M Manual
z
z
z
z
G Repeating flash
z
—
—
—
z
z
z
z
REAR Rear-curtain sync 4
1 Select mode P, S, A, or M, lower built-in flash, and use optional flash unit only.
2 Flash mode is automatically set to TTL and shutter-release is disabled. Set flash unit to A
(non-TTL auto flash).
3 Autofocus is available with AF-S VR Micro-Nikkor 105mm f/2.8G IF-ED and AF-S Micro NIKKOR
60mm f/2.8G ED lenses only.
4 Available when camera is used to select flash mode.
Flash unit

A The AS-15 Sync Terminal Adapter
When the AS-15 sync terminal adapter (available separately) is
mounted on the camera accessory shoe, flash accessories can be
connected via a sync cable.

D Use Only Nikon Flash Accessories
Use only Nikon flash units. Negative voltages or voltages over 250 V
applied to the accessory shoe could not only prevent normal
operation, but damage the sync circuitry of the camera or flash. Before
using a Nikon flash unit not listed in this section, contact a Nikonauthorized service representative for more information.

Technical Notes 317

D Notes on Optional Flash Units
Refer to the Speedlight manual for detailed instructions. If the flash
unit supports CLS, refer to the section on CLS-compatible digital SLR
cameras. The D5600 is not included in the “digital SLR” category in the
SB-80DX, SB-28DX, and SB-50DX manuals.
If an optional flash unit is attached in shooting modes other than j, %,
and 3, the flash will fire with every shot, even in modes in which the
built-in flash can not be used.
i-TTL flash control can be used at ISO sensitivities between 100 and
12800. At high ISO sensitivities, noise (lines) may appear in photos
taken with some optional flash units; if this occurs, choose a lower
value. If the flash-ready indicator flashes for about three seconds after
a photograph is taken, the flash has fired at full power and the
photograph may be underexposed (CLS-compatible flash units only;
for information on the exposure and flash charge indicators on other
units, see the manual provided with the flash).
When an SC-series 17, 28, or 29 sync cable is used for off-camera flash
photography, correct exposure may not be achieved in i-TTL mode.
We recommend that you choose spot metering to select standard
i-TTL flash control. Take a test shot and view the results in the monitor.
In i-TTL, use the flash panel or bounce adapter provided with the flash
unit. Do not use other panels such as diffusion panels, as this may
produce incorrect exposure.
If the controls on the optional SB-5000, SB-910, SB-900, SB-800, SB-700
or SB-600 flash unit or SU-800 wireless Speedlight commander are
used to set flash compensation, Y will appear in the information
display.

318 Technical Notes

The SB-5000, SB-910, SB-900, SB-800, SB-700, SB-600, SB-500, and
SB-400 provide red-eye reduction, while the SB-5000, SB-910, SB-900,
SB-800, SB-700, SB-600, and SU-800 provide AF-assist illumination with
the following restrictions:
• SB-5000: AF-assist illumination is
available with 24–135 mm AF
lenses, however, autofocus is
available only with the focus points
shown at right.

24–49 mm

50–69 mm

70–135 mm
• SB-910 and SB-900: AF-assist
illumination is available with
17–135 mm AF lenses, however,
autofocus is available only with the
focus points shown at right.

17–19 mm

20–105 mm

106–135 mm
• SB-800, SB-600, and SU-800: AF-assist
illumination is available with
24–105 mm AF lenses, however,
autofocus is available only with the
focus points shown at right.

24–34 mm

35–49 mm

50–105 mm

Technical Notes 319

• SB-700: AF-assist illumination is
available with 24–135 mm AF
lenses, however, autofocus is
available only with the focus points
shown at right.

24–135 mm

Depending on the lens used and scene recorded, the in-focus indicator
(I) may be displayed when the subject is not in focus, or the camera
may be unable to focus and the shutter release will be disabled.

320 Technical Notes

Other Accessories
At the time of writing, the following accessories were available
for the D5600.
Power sources • EN-EL14a Rechargeable Li-ion Battery (0 26): Additional
EN-EL14a batteries are available from local retailers and
Nikon-authorized service representatives. EN-EL14
batteries can also be used.
• MH-24 Battery Charger (0 26): Recharge EN-EL14a and
EN-EL14 batteries.
• EP-5A Power Connector, EH-5b/EH-5c AC Adapter: These
accessories can be used to power the camera for
extended periods (EH-5a and EH-5 AC adapters can also
be used). A power connector EP-5A is required to
connect the camera to the EH-5c, EH-5b, EH-5a, or EH-5;
see page 325 for details.
Accessory shoe BS-1 Accessory Shoe Cover: A cover protecting the accessory
covers
shoe. The accessory shoe is used for optional flash units.
Filters
• Filters intended for special-effects photography may
interfere with autofocus or the electronic rangefinder.
• The D5600 can not be used with linear polarizing filters.
Use C-PL or C-PL II circular polarizing filters instead.
• Neutral Color (NC) filters are recommended for
protecting the lens.
• To prevent ghosting, use of a filter is not recommended
when the subject is framed against a bright light, or
when a bright light source is in the frame.
• Center-weighted metering is recommended with filters
with exposure factors (filter factors) over 1× (Y44, Y48,
Y52, O56, R60, X0, X1, C-PL, ND2S, ND4, ND4S, ND8,
ND8S, ND400, A2, A12, B2, B8, B12). See the filter
manual for details.

Technical Notes 321

Viewfinder
eyepiece
accessories

• DK-5 Eyepiece Cap (0 80): Prevents light entering via the
viewfinder from appearing in the photograph or
interfering with exposure.
• DK-20C Eyepiece Correction Lenses: Lenses are available with
diopters of –5, –4, –3, –2, 0, +0.5, +1, +2, and +3 m–1
when the camera diopter adjustment control is in the
neutral position (–1 m–1). Use eyepiece correction
lenses only if the desired focus can not be achieved with
the built in diopter adjustment control (–1.7 to
+0.5 m–1). Test eyepiece correction lenses before
purchase to ensure that the desired focus can be
achieved. The rubber eyecup can not be used with
eyepiece correction lenses.
• DG-2 Magnifier: The DG-2 magnifies the scene displayed in
the center of the viewfinder for greater precision during
focusing. Eyepiece adapter required (available
separately). Note that because the DG-2 interferes with
the eye sensor, you may find it necessary to select Off
for the Info display auto off item in the setup menu
(0 265) when this accessory is attached.
• DK-22 Eyepiece Adapter: The DK-22 is used when attaching
the DG-2 magnifier. The monitor can not be rotated
with the adapter in place.
• DR-6 Right-Angle Viewing Attachment: The DR-6 attaches at a
right angle to the viewfinder eyepiece, allowing the
image in the viewfinder to be viewed at right angles to
the lens (for example, from directly above when the
camera is horizontal). The monitor can not be rotated
with the attachment in place. In addition, because the
DR-6 interferes with the eye sensor, you may find it
necessary to select Off for the Info display auto off
item in the setup menu when this accessory is attached.

322 Technical Notes

Software

Body caps

Wireless
remote
controllers

Microphones

Camera Control Pro 2: Control the camera remotely from a
computer to record movies and photographs and save
photographs directly to the computer hard disk.
Note: Use the latest versions of Nikon software; see the
websites listed on page xxi for the latest information on
supported operating systems. At default settings, Nikon
Message Center 2 will periodically check for updates to
Nikon software and firmware while you are logged in to
an account on the computer and the computer is
connected to the Internet. A message is automatically
displayed when an update is found.
BF-1B Body Cap/BF-1A Body Cap: The body cap keeps the
mirror, viewfinder screen, and image sensor free of dust
when a lens is not in place.
• WR-R10 Wireless Remote Controller/WR-T10 Wireless Remote
Controller: When a WR-R10 wireless remote controller is
attached, the camera can be controlled wirelessly using
a WR-T10 wireless remote controller (0 270).
• WR-1 Wireless Remote Controller (0 270): The WR-1 can
function as either a transmitter or a receiver and is used
in combination either with another WR-1 or a WR-R10 or
WR-T10 wireless remote controller. For example, a WR-1
can be connected to the accessory terminal for use as a
receiver, allowing the shutter to be released remotely by
another WR-1 acting as a transmitter.
• ME-1 Stereo Microphone (0 170)
• ME-W1 Wireless Microphone (0 170)

Technical Notes 323

Accessory
terminal
accessories

The D5600 is equipped with
an accessory terminal for
WR-1 and WR-R10 wireless
remote controllers, MC-DC2
remote cords (0 125), and
GP-1/GP-1A GPS units (0 269),
which connect with the H
mark on the connector aligned with the F next to the
accessory terminal (close the connector cover when the
terminal is not in use).

USB cables
HDMI cables
(0 218)

UC-E20 USB Cable (0 211, 214)
HC-E1 HDMI Cable: An HDMI cable with a type C connector
for connection to the camera and a type A connector for
connection to HDMI devices.

❚❚ Approved Memory Cards
The camera supports SD, SDHC, and SDXC memory
cards, including SDHC and SDXC cards compliant
with UHS-I. Cards rated UHS Speed Class 6 or better
are recommended for movie recording; using slower cards may
result in recording being interrupted. When choosing cards for
use in card readers, be sure they are compatible with the device.
Contact the manufacturer for information on features,
operation, and limitations on use.

A Optional Accessories
Availability may vary with country or region. See our website or
brochures for the latest information.

324 Technical Notes

Attaching a Power Connector and AC Adapter
Turn the camera off before attaching an optional power
connector and AC adapter.

1 Ready the camera.
Open the battery-chamber
(q) and power connector
(w) covers.

2 Insert the EP-5A power connector.
Be sure to insert the connector in the
orientation shown, using the
connector to keep the orange battery
latch pressed to one side. Be sure the
connector is fully inserted.

3 Close the battery-chamber cover.
Position the power
connector cable so that it
passes through the power
connector slot and close
the battery-chamber cover.

Technical Notes 325

4 Connect the EH-5b/EH-5c AC adapter.
Connect the AC adapter power cable to the AC socket on AC
adapter (e) and the power cable to the DC socket (r). A P
icon is displayed in the monitor when the camera is powered
by the AC adapter and power connector.

326 Technical Notes

Caring for the Camera
Storage
When the camera will not be used for an extended period,
remove the battery and store it in a cool, dry area with the
terminal cover in place. To prevent mold or mildew, store the
camera in a dry, well-ventilated area. Do not store your camera
with naphtha or camphor moth balls or in locations that:
• are poorly ventilated or subject to humidities of over 60%
• are next to equipment that produces strong electromagnetic
fields, such as televisions or radios
• are exposed to temperatures above 50 °C (122 °F) or below
–10 °C (14 °F)

Cleaning
Use a blower to remove dust and lint, then wipe gently
with a soft, dry cloth. After using the camera at the beach
or seaside, wipe off sand or salt with a cloth lightly
Camera body
dampened in distilled water and dry thoroughly.
Important: Dust or other foreign matter inside the camera may
cause damage not covered under warranty.
These glass elements are easily damaged. Remove dust
Lens, mirror, and lint with a blower. If using an aerosol blower, keep the
and
can vertical to prevent the discharge of liquid. To remove
viewfinder fingerprints and other stains, apply a small amount of lens
cleaner to a soft cloth and clean with care.
Remove dust and lint with a blower. When removing
fingerprints and other stains, wipe the surface lightly with
Monitor
a soft cloth or chamois leather. Do not apply pressure, as
this could result in damage or malfunction.

Do not use alcohol, thinner, or other volatile chemicals.

Technical Notes 327

Image Sensor Cleaning
If you suspect that dirt or dust on the image sensor is appearing
in photographs, you can clean the sensor using the Clean image
sensor option in the setup menu. The sensor can be cleaned at
any time using the Clean now option, or cleaning can be
performed automatically when the camera is turned on or off.

❚❚ “Clean Now”
Holding the camera base down, select
Clean image sensor in the setup menu,
then highlight Clean now and press J.
The camera will check the image sensor
and then begin cleaning. 1 flashes in
the viewfinder and other operations can
not be performed while cleaning is in
progress. Do not remove or disconnect
the power source until cleaning ends and
the setup menu is displayed.

328 Technical Notes

❚❚ “Clean at Startup/Shutdown”

1 Select Clean at startup/shutdown.
Select Clean image sensor, then
highlight Clean at startup/
shutdown and press 2.

2 Select an option.
Highlight an option and press J.
Choose from Clean at startup, Clean
at shutdown, Clean at startup &
shutdown, and Cleaning off.

D Image Sensor Cleaning
Using camera controls during startup interrupts image sensor
cleaning.
Cleaning is performed by vibrating the image sensor. If dust can not
be fully removed using the options in the Clean image sensor menu,
clean the image sensor manually (0 330) or consult a Nikonauthorized service representative.
If image sensor cleaning is performed several times in succession,
image sensor cleaning may be temporarily disabled to protect the
camera’s internal circuitry. Cleaning can be performed again after a
short wait.

Technical Notes 329

❚❚ Manual Cleaning
If foreign matter can not be removed from the image sensor
using the Clean image sensor option in the setup menu
(0 328), the sensor can be cleaned manually as described
below. Note, however, that the sensor is extremely delicate and
easily damaged. Nikon recommends that the sensor be cleaned
only by Nikon-authorized service personnel.

1 Charge the battery.
A reliable power source is required when inspecting or
cleaning the image sensor. Be sure the battery is fully
charged before proceeding.

2 Remove the lens.
Turn the camera off and remove the lens.

3 Select Lock mirror up for cleaning.
Turn the camera on and highlight
Lock mirror up for cleaning in the
setup menu and press 2 (note that
this option is not available at battery
levels of H or below).

4 Press J.
The message shown at right will be
displayed in the monitor.

5 Raise the mirror.
Press the shutter-release button all
the way down. The mirror will be
raised and the shutter curtain will
open, revealing the image sensor.
330 Technical Notes

6 Examine the image sensor.
Holding the camera so that light falls
on the image sensor, examine the
interior of the camera for dust or lint.
If no foreign objects are present,
proceed to Step 8.

7 Clean the sensor.
Remove any dust and lint from the
sensor with a blower. Do not use a
blower-brush, as the bristles could
damage the sensor. Dirt that can not
be removed with a blower can only be
removed by Nikon-authorized service
personnel. Under no circumstances should you touch or
wipe the sensor.

8 Turn the camera off.
The mirror will return to the down position and the shutter
curtain will close. Replace the lens or body cap.

A Use a Reliable Power Source
The shutter curtain is delicate and easily damaged. If the camera
powers off while the mirror is raised, the curtain will close
automatically. To prevent damage to the curtain, observe the
following precautions:
• Do not turn the camera off or remove or disconnect the power source
while the mirror is raised.
• If the battery runs low while the mirror is raised, a beep will sound
and the self-timer lamp will flash to warn that the shutter curtain will
close and the mirror will be lowered after about two minutes. End
cleaning or inspection immediately.

Technical Notes 331

D Foreign Matter on the Image Sensor
Foreign matter entering the camera when lenses or body caps are
removed or exchanged (or in rare circumstances lubricant or fine
particles from the camera itself) may adhere to the image sensor,
where it may appear in photographs taken under certain conditions.
To protect the camera when no lens is in place, be sure to replace the
body cap provided with the camera, being careful to first remove all
dust and other foreign matter that may be adhering to the camera
mount, lens mount, and body cap. Avoid attaching the body cap or
exchanging lenses in dusty environments.
Should foreign matter find its way onto the image sensor, use the
image sensor cleaning option as described on page 328. If the
problem persists, clean the sensor manually (0 330) or have the
sensor cleaned by authorized Nikon service personnel. Photographs
affected by the presence of foreign matter on the sensor can be
retouched using the clean image options available in some imaging
applications.

D Servicing the Camera and Accessories
The camera is a precision device and requires regular servicing. Nikon
recommends that the camera be inspected by the original retailer or
Nikon-authorized service representative once every one to two years,
and that it be serviced once every three to five years (note that fees
apply to these services). Frequent inspection and servicing are
particularly recommended if the camera is used professionally. Any
accessories regularly used with the camera, such as lenses or optional
flash units, should be included when the camera is inspected or
serviced.

332 Technical Notes

Caring for the Camera and Battery:
Cautions
Do not drop: The product may malfunction if subjected to strong shocks or
vibration.
Keep dry: This product is not waterproof, and may malfunction if
immersed in water or exposed to high levels of humidity. Rusting of the
internal mechanism can cause irreparable damage.
Avoid sudden changes in temperature: Sudden changes in temperature, such
as those that occur when entering or leaving a heated building on a cold
day, can cause condensation inside the device. To prevent
condensation, place the device in a carrying case or plastic bag before
exposing it to sudden changes in temperature.
Keep away from strong magnetic fields: Do not use or store this device in the
vicinity of equipment that generates strong electromagnetic radiation
or magnetic fields. Strong static charges or the magnetic fields
produced by equipment such as radio transmitters could interfere with
the monitor, damage data stored on the memory card, or affect the
product’s internal circuitry.
Do not leave the lens pointed at the sun: Do not leave the lens pointed at the
sun or other strong light source for an extended period. Intense light
may cause the image sensor to deteriorate or produce a white blur effect
in photographs.
Turn the product off before removing or disconnecting the power source: Do not
unplug the product or remove the battery while the product is on or
while images are being recorded or deleted. Forcibly cutting power in
these circumstances could result in loss of data or in damage to product
memory or internal circuitry. To prevent an accidental interruption of
power, avoid carrying the product from one location to another while
the AC adapter is connected.

Technical Notes 333

Cleaning: When cleaning the camera body, use a blower to gently remove
dust and lint, then wipe gently with a soft, dry cloth. After using the
camera at the beach or seaside, wipe off any sand or salt using a cloth
lightly dampened in pure water and then dry the camera thoroughly.
The lens and mirror are easily damaged. Dust and lint should be gently
removed with a blower. When using an aerosol blower, keep the can
vertical to prevent discharge of liquid. To remove fingerprints and other
stains from the lens, apply a small amount of lens cleaner to a soft cloth
and wipe the lens carefully.
See “Image Sensor Cleaning” (0 328, 330) for information on cleaning
the image sensor.
Do not touch the shutter curtain: The shutter curtain is extremely thin and
easily damaged. Under no circumstances should you exert pressure on
the curtain, poke it with cleaning tools, or subject it to powerful air
currents from a blower. These actions could scratch, deform, or tear the
curtain.
Storage: To prevent mold or mildew, store the camera in a dry, wellventilated area. If you are using an AC adapter, unplug the adapter to
prevent fire. If the product will not be used for an extended period,
remove the battery to prevent leakage and store the camera in a plastic
bag containing a desiccant. Do not, however, store the camera case in a
plastic bag, as this may cause the material to deteriorate. Note that
desiccant gradually loses its capacity to absorb moisture and should be
replaced at regular intervals.
To prevent mold or mildew, take the camera out of storage at least once
a month. Turn the camera on and release the shutter a few times before
putting it away.
Store the battery in a cool, dry place. Replace the terminal cover before
putting the battery away.

334 Technical Notes

Notes on the monitor: The monitor is constructed with extremely high
precision; at least 99.99% of pixels are effective, with no more than 0.01%
being missing or defective. Hence while these displays may contain
pixels that are always lit (white, red, blue, or green) or always off (black),
this is not a malfunction and has no effect on images recorded with the
device.
Images in the monitor may be difficult to see in a bright light.
Do not apply pressure to the monitor, as this could cause damage or
malfunction. Dust or lint on the monitor can be removed with a blower.
Stains can be removed by wiping lightly with a soft cloth or chamois
leather. Should the monitor break, care should be taken to avoid injury
from broken glass and to prevent liquid crystal from the monitor
touching the skin or entering the eyes and mouth.
Moiré: Moiré is an interference pattern created by the interaction of an
image containing a regular, repeating grid, such as the pattern of weave
in cloth or windows in a building, with the camera image sensor grid. If
you notice moiré in your photographs, try changing the distance to the
subject, zooming in and out, or changing the angle between the subject
and the camera.
The battery and charger: Batteries may leak or explode if improperly
handled. Read and follow the warnings and cautions on pages xiii–xvi of
this manual. Observe the following precautions when handling
batteries and chargers:
• Use only batteries approved for use in this equipment.
• Do not expose the battery to flame or excessive heat.
• Keep the battery terminals clean.
• Turn the product off before replacing the battery.
• Remove the battery from the camera or charger when not in use and
replace the terminal cover. These devices draw minute amounts of
charge even when off and could draw the battery down to the point
that it will no longer function. If the battery will not be used for some
time, insert it in the camera and run it flat before removing it and
storing it in a location with an ambient temperature of 15 °C to 25 °C
(59 °F to 77 °F; avoid hot or extremely cold locations). Repeat this
process at least once every six months.

Technical Notes 335

• Turning the camera on and off repeatedly when the battery is fully
discharged will shorten battery life. Batteries that have been fully
discharged must be charged before use.
• The internal temperature of the battery may rise while the battery is in
use. Attempting to charge the battery while the internal temperature
is elevated will impair battery performance, and the battery may not
charge or charge only partially. Wait for the battery to cool before
charging.
• Charge the battery indoors at ambient temperatures of 5 °C–35 °C
(41 °F–95 °F). Do not use the battery at ambient temperatures below
0 °C (32 °F) or above 40 °C (104 °F); failure to observe this precaution
could damage the battery or impair its performance. Capacity may be
reduced and charging times may increase at battery temperatures
from 0 °C (32 °F) to 15 °C (59 °F) and from 45 °C (113 °F) to 60 °C (140 °F).
The battery will not charge if its temperature is below 0 °C (32 °F) or
above 60 °C (140 °F).
• If the CHARGE lamp flashes quickly (about eight times a second) during
charging, confirm that the temperature is in the correct range and then
unplug the charger and remove and reinsert the battery. If the
problem persists, cease use immediately and take battery and charger
to your retailer or a Nikon-authorized service representative.
• Do not move the charger or touch the battery during charging. Failure
to observe this precaution could in very rare instances result in the
charger showing that charging is complete when the battery is only
partially charged. Remove and reinsert the battery to begin charging
again.
• Continuing to charge the battery after it is fully charged can impair
battery performance.
• A marked drop in the time a fully charged battery retains its charge
when used at room temperature indicates that it requires replacement.
Purchase a new EN-EL14a battery.
• Use the charger with compatible batteries only. Unplug when not in
use.
• Do not short the charger terminals. Failure to observe this precaution
could result in overheating and damage to the charger.

336 Technical Notes

• Charge the battery before use. When taking photographs on
important occasions, ready a spare battery and keep it fully charged.
Depending on your location, it may be difficult to purchase
replacement batteries on short notice. Note that on cold days, the
capacity of batteries tends to decrease. Be sure the battery is fully
charged before taking photographs outside in cold weather. Keep a
spare battery in a warm place and exchange the two as necessary.
Once warmed, a cold battery may recover some of its charge.
• Used batteries are a valuable resource; recycle in accord with local
regulations.

Technical Notes 337

Available Settings
The following table lists the settings that can be adjusted in each
mode. Note that some settings may be unavailable depending
on the options selected.

Shooting menu
Other settings

ISO sensitivity
White balance
Set Picture Control
Active D-Lighting
HDR (high dynamic
range)
Long exposure NR
High ISO NR
Time-lapse movie
Focus mode
(viewfinder)
AF-area mode
(viewfinder)
Focus mode (live
view/movie)
AF-area mode (live
view/movie)

338 Technical Notes

l,
m,
k, r,
p, t,
n, u,
o, v,
s, x,
P, S, w, y,
i j A, M 0 z
— — z z1 z1
— — z — —
— — z — —
—2 —2 z —2 —2

%
—
—
—
—

S,
T
z1
—
—
—

U
z1
—
—
—2

'
z1
—
—
—

(
z1
—
—
—

3
z1
—
—
—

1,
2,
3
z1
—
—
—

— — z — — — — — — — — —
z z z z z — z z z z z z
z z z z z — z z z z z z
z z z z z — — — — — — —
z z z z z — z z z z z z
z z z z z — z z z — z z
z z z z z z z z z z z z
— — z z z z3 z z3 z3 — z3 z

Other settings
Custom setting menu
1
2
3
4
5
6

Metering
Bracketing
Flash compensation
Exposure
compensation
Flash mode
a3: Built-in AF-assist
illuminator
e1: Flash cntrl for
built-in flash/
Optional flash
e2: Auto bracketing
set

i
—
—
—

j
—
—
—

P, S,
A, M
z
z
z

k,
p,
n,
o,
s,
w,
0
—
—
z

l,
m,
r,
t,
u,
v,
x,
y,
z
—
—
z

%
—
—
—

S,
T
—
—
—

U
—
—
—

'
—
—
—

(
—
—
—

3
—
—
—

1,
2,
3
—
—
—

— — z z z z — — — — — —
z — z z4 — — z z z — — —
z z z z5 z6 — z z z — z z
— — z — — — — — — — — —
— — z — — — — — — — — —

Auto ISO sensitivity control is not available.
Fixed at Auto.
Subject-tracking AF is not available.
Not available in 0 mode.
Not available in w mode.
Available only in x, y, and z modes.

Technical Notes 339

Troubleshooting
If the camera fails to function as expected, check the list of
common problems below before consulting your retailer or
Nikon-authorized service representative.

Battery/Display
The camera is on but does not respond: Wait for recording to end. If the
problem persists, turn the camera off. If the camera does not turn off,
remove and reinsert the battery or, if you are using an AC adapter,
disconnect and reconnect the AC adapter. Note that although any data
currently being recorded will be lost, data that have already been
recorded will not be affected by removing or disconnecting the power
source.
Viewfinder is out of focus: Adjust viewfinder focus (0 41). If this does not
correct the problem, select single-servo autofocus (AF-S; 0 82), singlepoint AF (c; 0 87), and the center focus point, and then frame a highcontrast subject in the center focus point and press the shutter-release
button halfway to focus the camera. With the camera in focus, use the
diopter adjustment control to bring the subject into clear focus in the
viewfinder. If necessary, viewfinder focus can be further adjusted using
optional corrective lenses (0 322).
Viewfinder is dark: Insert a fully-charged battery (0 26, 27).
Displays turn off without warning: Choose longer delays for Custom Setting
c2 (Auto off timers; 0 240).
Information display does not appear in monitor: Shutter-release button is
pressed halfway or eye sensor has turned display off. If information
display does not appear when you remove your finger from shutterrelease button or uncover eye sensor, confirm that On is selected for
Auto info display (0 265) and that battery is charged (0 26).
Viewfinder display is unresponsive and dim: The response times and brightness
of this display vary with temperature.

340 Technical Notes

Fine lines are visible around active focus point or display turns red when focus point is
highlighted: These phenomena are normal for this type of viewfinder and
do not indicate a malfunction.

Shooting (All Modes)
Camera takes time to turn on: Delete files or folders.
Shutter-release disabled:
• Memory card is locked, full, or not inserted (0 27, 351).
• Release locked is selected for Slot empty release lock (0 268) and no
memory card is inserted (0 27).
• Built-in flash is charging (0 54).
• Camera is not in focus (0 50).
• CPU lens with aperture ring attached but aperture not locked at
highest f-number (0 307).
• Non-CPU lens is attached but camera is not in mode M (0 308).
Only one shot taken each time shutter-release button is pressed in continuous shooting
mode: Continuous shooting is not available if built-in flash fires (0 77,
101).
Final photo is larger than area shown in viewfinder: Viewfinder horizontal and
vertical frame coverage is approximately 95%.
Photos are out of focus:
• AF-S, AF-P, or AF-I lens is not attached: use AF-S, AF-P, or AF-I lens or
focus manually.
• Camera unable to focus using autofocus: use manual focus or focus
lock (0 86, 93, 95).
• Camera is in manual focus mode: focus manually (0 95).
Focus does not lock when shutter-release button is pressed halfway: Use A (L)
button to lock focus when live view is off and AF-C is selected for focus
mode or when photographing moving subjects in AF-A mode (0 93).

Technical Notes 341

Can not select focus point:
• e (Auto-area AF; 0 88) is selected: choose another AF-area mode.
• Press shutter-release button halfway to start standby timer (0 53).
Can not select AF-area mode: Manual focus selected (0 82, 95).
AF-assist illuminator does not light:
• AF-assist illuminator does not light if AF-C is selected for autofocus
mode (0 82) or if continuous-servo autofocus is selected when the
camera is in AF-A mode. Choose AF-S. If an option other than e (Autoarea AF) is selected for AF-area mode, select center focus point (0 87,
90).
• The camera is currently in live view.
• Off is selected for Custom Setting a3 (Built-in AF-assist illuminator,
0 237).
• Illuminator has turned off automatically. Illuminator may become hot
with continued use; wait for it to cool down.
Image size can not be changed: Image quality set to NEF (RAW) (0 99).
Camera is slow to record photos:
• Depending on shooting conditions and memory card performance,
memory card access lamp may light for up to about a minute after
shooting ends in continuous release modes.
• Turn long exposure noise reduction off (0 230).

342 Technical Notes

Noise (bright spots, randomly-spaced bright pixels, fog, or lines) appear in photos:
• Bright spots, randomly-spaced bright pixels, fog, and lines can be
reduced by lowering ISO sensitivity.
• Use the Long exposure NR option in the shooting menu to limit the
occurrence of bright spots or fog in photos taken at shutter speeds
slower than 1 s (0 230).
• Fog and bright spots may indicate that the camera’s internal
temperature has become elevated due to high ambient temperatures,
long exposures, or similar causes: turn the camera off and wait for it to
cool before resuming shooting.
• At high ISO sensitivities, lines may appear in photos taken with some
optional flash units; if this occurs, choose a lower value.
• At high ISO sensitivities, including high values selected with auto ISO
sensitivity control, randomly-spaced bright pixels can be reduced by
selecting High, Normal, or Low for High ISO NR in the shooting menu
(0 231).
• At high ISO sensitivities, bright spots, randomly-spaced bright pixels,
fog, or lines may be more noticeable in long exposures, and photos
taken at high ambient temperatures or with Active D-Lighting enabled,
Flat selected for Set Picture Control (0 155) or extreme values
selected for Picture Control parameters (0 158).
• In % mode, randomly-spaced bright pixels, fog, or lines may be more
noticeable in pictures shot under low light.
Can not choose a release mode: Release mode selection is not available when
the monitor is off (0 75). Note that the eye sensor may turn the monitor
off automatically when you put your eye to the viewfinder.

Technical Notes 343

Beep does not sound:
• Off is selected for Beep options > Beep on/off (0 263).
• Camera is in quiet shutter-release mode (0 78), or movie is being
recorded (0 164).
• MF or AF-C is selected as the focus mode or subject moves when AF-A is
selected (0 82).
Smudges appear in photographs: Clean front and rear lens elements. If
problem persists, perform image sensor cleaning (0 328).
Date is not imprinted on photos: An NEF (RAW) option is selected for image
quality (0 99, 243).
Sound is not recorded with movies: Microphone off is selected for Movie
settings > Microphone (0 169).
Live view ends unexpectedly or does not start: Live view may end automatically
to prevent damage to the camera’s internal circuits if:
• The ambient temperature is high
• The camera has been used for extended periods in live view or to
record movies
• The camera has been used in continuous release modes for extended
periods
If live view does not start when you attempt to start live view, wait for the
internal circuits to cool and then try again. Note that the camera may
feel warm to the touch, but this does not indicate a malfunction.
Image artifacts appear during live view: “Noise” (randomly-spaced bright
pixels, fog, or lines) and unexpected colors may appear if you zoom in on
the view through the lens (0 53) during live view; in movies, the amount
and distribution of randomly-spaced bright pixels, fog, and bright spots
are affected by frame size and rate (0 168). Randomly-spaced bright
pixels, fog, or bright spots may also arise as a result of increases in the
temperature of the camera’s internal circuits during live view; exit live
view when the camera is not in use.

344 Technical Notes

Flicker or banding appears during live view or movie recording: Choose an option
for Flicker reduction that matches the frequency of the local AC power
supply (0 268).
Bright bands appear during live view or movie recording: A flashing sign, flash, or
other light source with brief duration was used during live view or movie
recording.
Menu item can not be selected: Some options are not available in all modes.

Shooting (P, S, A, M)
Shutter-release disabled:
• Non-CPU lens is attached: rotate camera mode dial to M (0 308).
• Mode dial rotated to S after shutter speed of “Bulb” or “Time” selected
in mode M: choose new shutter speed (0 121).
• If white-balance bracketing is active, shutter release will be disabled
and viewfinder exposure-count display will flash if there is insufficient
space on memory card to record all images in bracketing sequence.
Insert new memory card.
Full range of shutter speeds not available:
• Flash in use (0 106).
• When On is selected for Movie settings > Manual movie settings in
the shooting menu, the range of available shutter speed varies with the
frame rate (0 169).
Can not select desired aperture: Range of available apertures varies with lens
used.
Colors are unnatural:
• Adjust white balance to match light source (0 140).
• Adjust Set Picture Control settings (0 155).
Can not measure white balance: Subject is too dark or too bright (0 147).

Technical Notes 345

Image can not be selected as source for preset white balance: Image was not
created with D5600 (0 149).
White balance bracketing unavailable: NEF (RAW) or NEF+JPEG image quality
option selected for image quality (0 98).
Effects of Picture Control differ from image to image: A (auto) is selected for
sharpening, clarity, contrast, or saturation. For consistent results over a
series of photos, choose another setting (0 159).
Metering can not be changed: Autoexposure lock is in effect (0 130).
Exposure compensation can not be used: Camera is in mode M. Choose another
mode (0 118, 132).
Noise (reddish areas or other artifacts) appears in long time-exposures: Enable long
exposure noise reduction (0 230).

Playback
NEF (RAW) image is not played back: Photo was taken at image quality of NEF
(RAW)+JPEG (0 98).
Can not view pictures recorded with other cameras: Pictures recorded with other
makes of camera may not be displayed correctly.
Some pictures are not displayed during playback: Select All for Playback folder
(0 221).
“Tall” (portrait) orientation photos are displayed in “wide” (landscape) orientation:
• Select On for Rotate tall (0 222).
• Photo was taken with Off selected for Auto image rotation (0 222).
• Photo is displayed in image review (0 221).
• Camera was pointed up or down when photo was taken (0 222).
Can not delete picture:
• Picture is protected: remove protection (0 200).
• Memory card is locked (0 350).

346 Technical Notes

Can not retouch picture: Photo can not be further edited with this camera
(0 279).
Can not select photo for printing: Photo is in NEF (RAW) format. Transfer
photos to computer and print using Capture NX-D (0 210). NEF (RAW)
photos can be saved in JPEG format using NEF (RAW) processing
(0 280).
Picture is not displayed on TV: HDMI (0 218) cable is not correctly connected.
Camera does not respond to remote control for HDMI-CEC television:
• Select On for HDMI > Device control in the setup menu (0 219).
• Adjust HDMI-CEC settings for the television as described in
documentation provided with the device.
Can not transfer photos to computer: OS not compatible with camera or
transfer software. Use card reader to copy photos to computer.
Image Dust Off option in Capture NX-D does not have desired effect: Image sensor
cleaning changes the position of dust on the image sensor. Image Dust
Off reference data recorded before image sensor cleaning is performed
can not be used with photographs taken after image sensor cleaning is
performed. Image Dust Off reference data recorded after image sensor
cleaning is performed can not be used with photographs taken before
image sensor cleaning is performed (0 266).
Computer displays NEF (RAW) images differently from camera: Third-party
software does not display effects of Picture Controls, Active D-Lighting,
or vignette control. Use Capture NX-D (0 210).

Technical Notes 347

Bluetooth and Wi-Fi (Wireless Networks)
Smart devices do not display the camera SSID (network name):
• Confirm that Disable is selected for Airplane mode in the camera
setup menu (0 271).
• Confirm that Enable is selected for Bluetooth > Network connection
in the camera setup menu.
• Try turning the smart device Wi-Fi off and then on again.
Can not connect to smart devices using NFC: Choose another connection
method.
Can not connect to wireless printers and other wireless devices: This camera can
connect only to devices to which the SnapBridge app has been installed.

Miscellaneous
Date of recording is not correct: Set camera clock (0 40, 262).
Menu item can not be selected: Some options are not available at certain
combinations of settings or when no memory card is inserted (0 27,
277, 338).

348 Technical Notes

Error Messages
This section lists the indicators and error messages that appear
in the viewfinder and monitor.
A Warning Icons
A flashing d in the monitor or s in the viewfinder indicates that a
warning or error message can be displayed in the monitor by pressing
the W (Q) button.

Indicator
Monitor
Viewfinder
Lock lens aperture ring
at minimum aperture
(largest f/-number).

B
(flashes)

Lens not attached

F/s
(flashes)

Before taking photos,
rotate the zoom ring to
extend the lens.

F
(flashes)

Shutter release disabled.
Recharge battery.
This battery cannot be
used. It does not
communicate properly
with this camera. To use
the camera safely,
choose a battery
designated for use in
this camera.

d/s
(flashes)

0

Solution

Set lens aperture ring to
minimum aperture (highest
307
f-number).
• Attach non-IX NIKKOR lens.
307
• If non-CPU lens is attached, 123
select mode M.
A lens with a retractable lens
barrel button is attached with
the lens barrel retracted. Press
31
the retractable lens barrel
button and rotate the zoom
ring to extend the lens.
Turn camera off and recharge
26, 27
or replace battery.

d
Use Nikon-approved battery.
(flashes)

321

Technical Notes 349

Indicator
Monitor
Viewfinder

Solution

Initialization error. Turn
Turn camera off, remove and
d/k
camera off and then on
replace battery, and then turn
(flashes)
again.
camera on again.
Battery level is low.
End cleaning and turn camera
Complete operation and
—
off and recharge or replace
turn camera off
battery.
immediately.
s
Clock not set
Set camera clock.
(flashes)
No memory card
S/s Turn camera off and confirm
inserted
(flashes) that card is correctly inserted.
Memory card is locked (write
Memory card is locked.
(
protected). Slide card writeSlide lock to “write”
(flashes) protect switch to “write”
position.
position.
• Use approved card.
• Format card. If problem
persists, card may be
damaged. Contact Nikonauthorized service
representative.
• Error creating new folder.
Delete files or insert new
Cannot access this
(/k
memory card.
memory card.
(flashes)
Insert another card.
• Insert new memory card.
• Eye-Fi card is still emitting
wireless signal after Disable
has been selected for Eye-Fi
upload. To terminate
wireless transmission, turn
the camera off and remove
the card.

350 Technical Notes

0
27

331
40,
262
27

—
324
259

27,
205
27
274

Indicator
Monitor
Viewfinder
Not available if Eye-Fi
card is locked.

(/k
(flashes)

This card is not
formatted.
Format the card.

T
(flashes)

Card is full

j/A/s
(flashes)

—

●
(flashes)

Subject is too bright
s
(flashes)

Subject is too dark

Solution

0

Eye-Fi card is locked (write
protected). Slide card write—
protect switch to “write”
position.
Format card or turn camera
27,
off and insert new memory
259
card.
• Reduce quality or size.
98
• Delete photographs.
205
• Insert new memory card.
27
Camera can not focus using
50, 86,
autofocus. Change
composition or focus
95
manually.
• Use a lower ISO sensitivity.
107
• Use commercial ND filter.
321
• In mode:
S Increase shutter speed
121
A Choose a smaller
122
aperture (higher
f-number)
% Choose another
4, 65
shooting mode
• Use a higher ISO sensitivity. 107
• Use flash.
101
• In mode:
S Lower shutter speed
121
A Choose a larger aperture 122
(lower f-number)

Technical Notes 351

Indicator
Monitor
Viewfinder
No “Bulb” in S mode
No “Time” in S mode
No “Bulb” in HDR mode
No “Time” in HDR mode

A/s
(flashes)
&/s
(flashes)
A/s
(flashes)
&/s
(flashes)

Interval timer shooting

—

Time-lapse photography

—

352 Technical Notes

Solution

0

Change shutter speed or
select mode M.

121,
123

• Change shutter speed.

124,
125
138

• Turn HDR off.
Menus and playback are not
available while interval timer
photography is in progress. To
pause, press J.
Menus and playback are not
available while time-lapse
photography is in progress.

109

175

Indicator
Monitor
Viewfinder
—

—

Error. Press shutter
release button again.
Start-up error. Contact a
Nikon-authorized
service representative.
Metering error
Unable to start live view.
Please wait for camera
to cool.

0

Solution

Flash has fired at full power.
Check photo in monitor; if
N
—
(flashes) underexposed, adjust
settings and try again.
• Use the flash.
101
• Change distance to subject, 106,
aperture, flash range, or ISO 107,
sensitivity.
122
• Lens focal length is less than —
18 mm: use a longer focal
length.
N/s
—
• Optional SB-400 or SB-300
(flashes)
flash unit attached: flash is in
bounce position or focus
distance is very short.
Continue shooting; if
necessary, increase focus
distance to prevent
shadows from appearing in
photograph.
Release shutter. If error
persists or appears frequently,
—
consult Nikon-authorized
service representative.
O
(flashes)
Consult Nikon-authorized
—
service representative.

—

Wait for the internal circuits to
cool before resuming live
view or movie recording.

344

Technical Notes 353

Indicator
Monitor
Viewfinder

Folder contains no
images.

—

Cannot display this file.

—

Cannot select this file.

—

This movie cannot be
edited.

—

No image for retouching.

—

Network access not
available until camera
cools.

—

354 Technical Notes

Solution
Folder selected for playback
contains no images. Select
folder containing images
from Playback folder menu
or insert memory card
containing images.
File can not be played back on
camera.
Images created with other
devices can not be retouched.
• Movies created with other
devices can not be edited.
• Movies must be at least two
seconds long.
Memory card does not
contain NEF (RAW) images for
use with NEF (RAW)
processing.
Turn camera off and try again
after waiting for camera to
cool.

0

27,
221

—
278
278
178

280

—

Indicator
Monitor
Viewfinder
Check printer.

—

Check paper.

—

Paper jam.

—

Out of paper.

—

Check ink supply.

—

Out of ink.

—

0

Solution
Check printer. To resume,
select Continue (if available).
Paper is not selected size.
Insert paper of correct size
and select Continue.
Clear jam and select
Continue.
Insert paper of selected size
and select Continue.
Check ink. To resume, select
Continue.
Replace ink and select
Continue.

—*
—*
—*
—*
—*
—*

* See printer manual for more information.

Technical Notes 355

Specifications
❚❚ Nikon D5600 Digital Camera
Type
Type
Lens mount
Effective angle of view

Effective pixels
Effective pixels
Image sensor
Image sensor
Total pixels
Dust-reduction System

Storage
Image size (pixels)

File format

Picture Control System

Media
File system

356 Technical Notes

Single-lens reflex digital camera
Nikon F mount (with AF contacts)
Nikon DX format; focal length equivalent to
approx. 1.5× that of lenses with FX format angle
of view
24.2 million
23.5 × 15.6 mm CMOS sensor
24.78 million
Image sensor cleaning, Image Dust Off
reference data (Capture NX-D software
required)
• 6000 × 4000 (Large)
• 4496 × 3000 (Medium)
• 2992 × 2000 (Small)
• NEF (RAW): 12- or 14 bit, compressed
• JPEG: JPEG-Baseline compliant with fine
(approx. 1 : 4), normal (approx. 1 : 8), or basic
(approx. 1 : 16) compression
• NEF (RAW)+JPEG: Single photograph recorded in
both NEF (RAW) and JPEG formats
Standard, Neutral, Vivid, Monochrome, Portrait,
Landscape, Flat; selected Picture Control can be
modified; storage for custom Picture Controls
SD (Secure Digital) and UHS-I compliant SDHC
and SDXC memory cards
DCF 2.0, Exif 2.3, PictBridge

Viewfinder
Viewfinder
Frame coverage
Magnification
Eyepoint
Diopter adjustment
Focusing screen
Reflex mirror
Lens aperture
Lens
Autofocus support
Shutter
Type
Speed
Flash sync speed
Release
Release mode

Frame advance rate

Self-timer

Eye-level pentamirror single-lens reflex
viewfinder
Approx. 95% horizontal and 95% vertical
Approx. 0.82× (50 mm f/1.4 lens at infinity,
–1.0 m–1)
17 mm (–1.0 m–1; from center surface of
viewfinder eyepiece lens)
–1.7–+0.5 m–1
Type B BriteView Clear Matte Mark VII screen
Quick return
Instant return, electronically controlled
Autofocus is available with AF-S, AF-P, and AF-I
lenses.
Electronically-controlled vertical-travel focalplane shutter
1/4000 – 30 s in steps of 1/3 or 1/2 EV; Bulb; Time
X= 1/200 s; synchronizes with shutter at 1/200 s or
slower
8 (single frame), ! (continuous L),
9 (continuous H), J (quiet shutter release),
E (self-timer); interval timer photography
supported
• !: Up to 3 fps
• 9: Up to 5 fps (JPEG and 12-bit NEF/RAW) or
4 fps (14-bit NEF/RAW)
Note: Frame rates assume continuous-servo AF,
manual or shutter-priority auto exposure, a
shutter speed of 1/250 s or faster, Release
selected for Custom Setting a1 (AF-C priority
selection), and other settings at default values.
2 s, 5 s, 10 s, 20 s; 1–9 exposures

Technical Notes 357

Exposure
Metering mode

TTL exposure metering using 2016-pixel RGB
sensor
Metering method
• Matrix metering: 3D color matrix metering II
(type G, E, and D lenses); color matrix
metering II (other CPU lenses)
• Center-weighted metering: Weight of 75% given
to 8-mm circle in center of frame
• Spot metering: Meters 3.5-mm circle (about
2.5% of frame) centered on selected focus
point
Range (ISO 100, f/1.4 lens, • Matrix or center-weighted metering: 0–20 EV
20 °C/68 °F)
• Spot metering: 2–20 EV
Exposure meter coupling CPU
Mode
Auto modes (i auto; j auto, flash off );
programmed auto with flexible program (P);
shutter-priority auto (S); aperture-priority auto
(A); manual (M); scene modes (k portrait;
l landscape; p child; m sports; n close up;
o night portrait; r night landscape; s party/
indoor; t beach/snow; u sunset; v dusk/
dawn; w pet portrait; x candlelight; y blossom;
z autumn colors; 0 food); special effects modes
(% night vision; S super vivid; T pop; U photo
illustration; ' toy camera effect; ( miniature
effect; 3 selective color; 1 silhouette; 2 high
key; 3 low key)
Exposure compensation Can be adjusted by –5 – +5 EV in increments of
1/3 or 1/2 EV in P, S, A, M, h, and % modes

358 Technical Notes

Exposure
Exposure lock

Luminosity locked at detected value with
A (L) button
ISO sensitivity
ISO 100 – 25600 in steps of 1/3 EV. Auto ISO
(Recommended Exposure sensitivity control available
Index)
Active D-Lighting
Y Auto, Z Extra high, P High, Q Normal,
R Low, ! Off

Focus
Autofocus

Detection range
Lens servo

Focus point
AF-area mode
Focus lock

Nikon Multi-CAM 4800DX autofocus sensor
module with TTL phase detection, 39 focus
points (including 9 cross-type sensors), and
AF-assist illuminator (range approx. 0.5–3 m/
1 ft 8 in.–9 ft 10 in.)
–1 – +19 EV (ISO 100, 20 °C/68 °F)
• Autofocus (AF): Single-servo AF (AF-S);
continuous-servo AF (AF-C); auto AF-S/AF-C
selection (AF-A); predictive focus tracking
activated automatically according to subject
status
• Manual focus (MF): Electronic rangefinder can be
used
Can be selected from 39 or 11 focus points
Single-point AF, 9-, 21-, or 39- point dynamicarea AF, 3D-tracking, auto-area AF
Focus can be locked by pressing shutter-release
button halfway (single-servo AF) or by pressing
A (L) button

Technical Notes 359

Flash
Built-in flash

Guide Number
Flash control

Flash mode

Flash compensation
Flash-ready indicator

Accessory shoe
Nikon Creative Lighting
System (CLS)
Sync terminal
White balance
White balance

Bracketing
Bracketing types

360 Technical Notes

i, k, p, n, o, s, w, S, T, U, ' : Auto flash
with auto pop-up
P, S, A, M, 0: Manual pop-up with button release
Approx. 12/39, 12/39 with manual flash (m/ft,
ISO 100, 20 °C/68 °F)
TTL: i-TTL flash control using 2016-pixel RGB
sensor is available with built-in flash; i-TTL
balanced fill-flash for digital SLR is used with
matrix and center-weighted metering, standard
i-TTL flash for digital SLR with spot metering
Auto, auto with red-eye reduction, auto slow
sync, auto slow sync with red-eye reduction, fillflash, red-eye reduction, slow sync, slow sync
with red-eye reduction, rear-curtain with slow
sync, rear-curtain sync, off
Can be adjusted by –3 – +1 EV in increments of
1/3 or 1/2 EV in P, S, A, M, and h modes
Lights when built-in flash or optional flash unit
is fully charged; blinks after flash is fired at full
output
ISO 518 hot-shoe with sync and data contacts
and safety lock
Nikon CLS supported
AS-15 sync terminal adapter (available
separately)
Auto, incandescent, fluorescent (7 types), direct
sunlight, flash, cloudy, shade, preset manual, all
except preset manual with fine-tuning.
Exposure, white balance, and ADL

Live view
Lens servo

• Autofocus (AF): Single-servo AF (AF-S); full-timeservo AF (AF-F)
• Manual focus (MF)
AF-area mode
Face-priority AF, wide-area AF, normal-area AF,
subject-tracking AF
Autofocus
Contrast-detect AF anywhere in frame (camera
selects focus point automatically when facepriority AF or subject-tracking AF is selected)
Automatic scene selection Available in i and j modes

Movie
Metering
Metering method
Frame size (pixels) and
frame rate

File format
Video compression
Audio recording format
Audio recording device
ISO sensitivity
Other options
Monitor
Monitor

TTL exposure metering using main image
sensor
Matrix
• 1920 × 1080; 60p (progressive), 50p, 30p, 25p,
24p
• 1280 × 720; 60p, 50p
Actual frame rates for 60p, 50p, 30p, 25p, and
24p are 59.94, 50, 29.97, 25, and 23.976 fps
respectively; options support both ★ high and
normal image quality
MOV
H.264/MPEG-4 Advanced Video Coding
Linear PCM
Built-in or external stereo microphone;
sensitivity adjustable
ISO 100–25600
Time-lapse movies
8.1 cm/3.2-in. (3 : 2), approx. 1037k-dot (720 ×
480 × 3 = 1,036,800 dots), TFT vari-angle LCD
touch screen with 170 ° viewing angle, approx.
100% frame coverage, brightness adjustment,
and eye-sensor controlled on/off

Technical Notes 361

Playback
Playback

Interface
USB

HDMI output
Accessory terminal

ZAudio input
Wireless/Bluetooth
Wireless

Bluetooth
Range (line of sight)

NFC
Operation

362 Technical Notes

Full-frame and thumbnail (4, 12, or 80 images or
calendar) playback with playback zoom,
playback zoom cropping, playback face zoom,
movie playback, photo and/or movie slide
shows, histogram display, highlights, photo
information, location data display, auto image
rotation, picture rating, and image comment
(up to 36 characters)
Hi-Speed USB with Micro-USB connector;
connection to built-in USB port is
recommended
Type C HDMI connector
• Wireless remote controllers: WR-1, WR-R10
(available separately)
• Remote cords: MC-DC2 (available separately)
• GPS units: GP-1/GP-1A (available separately)
Stereo mini-pin jack (3.5 mm diameter);
supports optional ME-1 stereo microphones
• Standards: IEEE 802.11b, IEEE 802.11g
• Operating frequency: 2412–2462 MHz
(channels 1–11)
• Authentication: Open system, WPA2-PSK
Communication protocols: Bluetooth Specification
Version 4.1
Approximately 10 m (32 ft) without
interference; range may vary with signal
strength and presence or absence of obstacles
NFC Forum Type 3 Tag

Supported languages
Supported languages

Power source
Battery
AC adapter
Tripod socket
Tripod socket
Dimensions/weight
Dimensions (W × H × D)
Weight

Arabic, Bengali, Bulgarian, Chinese (Simplified
and Traditional), Czech, Danish, Dutch, English,
Finnish, French, German, Greek, Hindi,
Hungarian, Indonesian, Italian, Japanese,
Korean, Marathi, Norwegian, Persian, Polish,
Portuguese (Portugal and Brazil), Romanian,
Russian, Serbian, Spanish, Swedish, Tamil,
Telugu, Thai, Turkish, Ukrainian, Vietnamese
One EN-EL14a rechargeable Li-ion battery
EH-5b/EH-5c AC adapter; requires EP-5A power
connector (available separately)
1/4

in. (ISO 1222)

Approx. 124 × 97 × 70 mm (4.9 × 3.9 × 2.8 in.)
Approx. 465 g (1 lb 0.4 oz) with battery and
memory card but without body cap; approx.
415 g/14.7 oz (camera body only)

Operating environment
Temperature
0 °C–40 °C (+32 °F–104 °F)
Humidity
85% or less (no condensation)
• Unless otherwise stated, all measurements are performed in conformity with Camera and
Imaging Products Association (CIPA) standards or guidelines.
• All figures are for a camera with a fully-charged battery.
• Nikon reserves the right to change the appearance and specifications of the hardware and
software described in this manual at any time and without prior notice. Nikon will not be held
liable for damages that may result from any mistakes that this manual may contain.

Technical Notes 363

❚❚ MH-24 Battery Charger
AC 100–240 V, 50/60 Hz, 0.2 A maximum
DC 8.4 V/0.9 A
Nikon EN-EL14a rechargeable Li-ion batteries
Approx. 1 hour and 50 minutes at an ambient
temperature of 25 °C (77 °F) when no charge
remains
Operating temperature
0 °C–40 °C (+32 °F–104 °F)
Dimensions (W × H × D)
Approx. 70 × 26 × 97 mm (2.8 × 1.0 × 3.8 in.),
excluding plug adapter
Weight
Approx. 96 g (3.4 oz), excluding plug adapter
The symbols on this product represent the following:
m AC, p DC, q Class II equipment (The construction of the product is double-insulated.)
Rated input
Rated output
Supported batteries
Charging time

❚❚ EN-EL14a Rechargeable Li-ion Battery
Type
Rated capacity
Operating temperature
Dimensions (W × H × D)
Weight

Rechargeable lithium-ion battery
7.2 V/1230 mAh
0°C–40 °C (+32 °F–104 °F)
Approx. 38 × 53 × 14 mm (1.5 × 2.1 × 0.6 in.)
Approx. 49 g (1.7 oz), excluding terminal cover

Nikon reserves the right to change the appearance and specifications of the hardware and
software described in this manual at any time and without prior notice. Nikon will not be held
liable for damages that may result from any mistakes that this manual may contain.

364 Technical Notes

❚❚ Supported Standards
• DCF Version 2.0: The Design Rule for Camera File Systems (DCF)
is a standard widely used in the digital camera industry to
ensure compatibility among different makes of camera.
• Exif version 2.3: The camera supports Exif (Exchangeable Image
File Format for Digital Still Cameras) version 2.3, a standard in
which information stored with photographs is used for
optimal color reproduction when the images are output on
Exif-compliant printers.
• PictBridge: A standard developed through cooperation with
the digital camera and printer industries, allowing
photographs to be output directly to a printer without first
transferring them to a computer.
• HDMI: High-Definition Multimedia Interface is a standard for
multimedia interfaces used in consumer electronics and AV
devices capable of transmitting audiovisual data and control
signals to HDMI-compliant devices via a single cable
connection.

Technical Notes 365

A Trademark Information
IOS is a trademark or registered trademark of Cisco Systems, Inc., in the
United States and/or other countries and is used under license.
Windows is either a registered trademark or a trademark of Microsoft
Corporation in the United States and/or other countries. Mac, OS X,
Apple®, App Store®, the Apple logos, iPhone®, iPad®, and iPod touch®
are trademarks of Apple Inc. registered in the U.S. and/or other
countries. Android is a trademark of Google Inc. The Android robot is
reproduced or modified from work created and shared by Google and
used according to terms described in the Creative Commons 3.0
Attribution License. PictBridge logo is a trademark. The SD, SDHC, and
SDXC logos are trademarks of the SD-3C, LLC. HDMI, the HDMI logo
and High-Definition Multimedia Interface are trademarks or registered
trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC.

Wi-Fi and the Wi-Fi logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of the
Wi-Fi Alliance. N-Mark is a trademark or registered trademark of NFC
Forum, Inc., in the United States and/or other countries.
The Bluetooth® word mark and logos are registered trademarks owned
by Bluetooth SIG, Inc. and any use of such marks by Nikon Corporation
is under license.
All other trade names mentioned in this manual or the other
documentation provided with your Nikon product are trademarks or
registered trademarks of their respective holders.
“Made for iPod,” “Made for iPhone,” and “Made for iPad” mean that an
electronic accessory has been designed to connect specifically to
iPod, iPhone, or iPad, respectively, and has been certified by the
developer to meet Apple performance standards. Apple is not
responsible for the operation of this device or its compliance with
safety and regulatory standards. Please note that the use of this
accessory with iPod, iPhone, or iPad may affect wireless performance.

366 Technical Notes

A Conformity Marking
The standards with which the camera complies can be viewed using
the Conformity marking option in the setup menu (0 276).

A FreeType License (FreeType2)
Portions of this software are copyright © 2012 The FreeType Project
(http://www.freetype.org). All rights reserved.

A MIT License (HarfBuzz)
Portions of this software are copyright © 2016 The HarfBuzz Project
(http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/HarfBuzz). All rights
reserved.

Technical Notes 367

A Certificates

368 Technical Notes

Lens Kits
The camera can be purchased as a kit with the lens listed below.

AF-P DX NIKKOR 18–55mm f/3.5–5.6G VR
This retractable lens is for use exclusively with DX format Nikon
digital SLR cameras; SLR film cameras and D4-series, D3-series,
D2-series, D1-series, D800-series, D700, D610, D600, D300-series,
D200, D100, D90, D80, D70-series, D60, D50, D40-series, D7000,
D5100, D5000, D3200, D3100, D3000 digital SLR cameras are not
supported. When using these lenses with a D5500, D5300, or
D3300, be sure the camera firmware has been updated to the
latest version. The parts of the lens are listed below.

1 Lens cap

6 Lens mounting mark.................... 30

2 Lens hood mounting mark

7 CPU contacts................................307

3 Retractable lens barrel button... 31

8 Focus ring ....................................... 95

4 Focal length scale
5 Focal length mark

9 Zoom ring ....................................... 49
10 Rear lens cap

Technical Notes 369

❚❚ Focus
The focus mode can be selected using camera controls (0 82).
Autofocus
Focus is adjusted automatically when the camera is in autofocus
mode (0 82). The focus ring can also be used to focus the
camera if the shutter-release button is kept pressed halfway (or
if the AF-ON button is kept pressed); this is known as “autofocus
with manual override” (M/A). Autofocus will resume when the
shutter-release button is pressed halfway (or the AF-ON button
is pressed) a second time. Note that touching the focus ring
while autofocus is in effect will change the focus position.
Manual Focus
When the camera is in manual focus mode, focus can be
adjusted by rotating the lens focus ring (0 95). When the
camera is off or the standby timer has expired, the focus ring can
not be used to focus and rotating the zoom ring will change the
focus position; before focusing, turn the camera on or press the
shutter-release button to reactivate the standby timer.
Users of D5, D810-series, Df, D750, D7200, D7100, and D5200
cameras should note that if the standby timer is allowed to
expire, the focus position will change when the timer is
restarted. Refocus before shooting. Longer standby times are
recommended for manual focus and in other situations in which
you may not release the shutter immediately after focusing.

370 Technical Notes

❚❚ Using the Built-in Flash
When using the built-in flash, be sure the subject is at a range of
at least 0.6 m (2 ft) and remove lens hoods to prevent vignetting
(shadows created where the end of the lens obscures the built-in
flash).

Shadow

Vignetting

When the lens is mounted on the following cameras, the built-in
flash may be unable to light the entire subject at ranges less than
those given below:
Camera
D5600/D5500/D5300/D5200/
D3400/D3300

Zoom position
18 mm
24, 35, 45, and
55 mm

Minimum distance
without vignetting
1.0 m/3 ft 4 in.
No vignetting

Technical Notes 371

❚❚ Vibration Reduction (VR)
When an AF-P DX NIKKOR 18–55mm f/3.5–5.6G VR is mounted
on the camera, vibration reduction can be enabled or disabled
using the Optical VR option in the shooting menu (0 232). If On
is selected, vibration reduction will take effect whenever the
shutter-release button is pressed halfway. Vibration reduction
reduces blur caused by camera shake, allowing shutter speeds
up to 4.0 stops slower than would otherwise be the case,
increasing the range of shutter speeds available. The effects of
VR on shutter speed are measured according to Camera and
Imaging Products Association (CIPA) standards; FX-format lenses
are measured using FX-format digital cameras, DX-format lenses
using DX-format cameras. Zoom lenses are measured at
maximum zoom.

D Vibration Reduction
• When using vibration reduction, press the shutter-release button
halfway and wait for the image in the viewfinder to stabilize before
pressing the shutter-release button the rest of the way down.
• When vibration reduction is active, the image in the viewfinder may
jiggle after the shutter is released. This does not indicate a
malfunction.
• When the camera is panned, vibration reduction applies only to
motion that is not part of the pan (if the camera is panned
horizontally, for example, vibration reduction will be applied only to
vertical shake), making it much easier to pan the camera smoothly in
a wide arc.
• If the camera is equipped with a built-in flash, vibration reduction will
be disabled while the flash charges.
• Vibration reduction is generally recommended when the camera is
mounted on a tripod, although you may prefer to turn it off
depending on shooting conditions and the type of tripod.
• Vibration reduction is recommended when the camera is mounted
on a monopod.

372 Technical Notes

❚❚ Supplied Accessories
• LC-55A 55 mm Snap-on Front Lens Cap
• Rear Lens Cap

❚❚ Compatible Accessories
•
•
•
•

55 mm screw-on filters
LF-4 Rear Lens Cap
CL-0815 Lens Case
HB-N106 Bayonet Hood
Align the lens hood mounting mark (●) with the lens hood
alignment mark ( ) as shown in Figure q and then rotate
the hood (w) until the ● mark is aligned with the lens hood
lock mark (—).

When attaching or removing the hood, hold it near the symbol
on its base and avoid gripping it too tightly. Vignetting may
occur if the hood is not correctly attached. The hood can be
reversed and mounted on the lens when not in use.

Technical Notes 373

❚❚ Specifications
Type
Focal length
Maximum aperture
Lens construction
Angle of view
Focal length scale
Distance information
Zoom
Focusing
Vibration reduction
Minimum focus distance
Diaphragm blades
Diaphragm
Aperture range

Metering
Filter-attachment size
Dimensions

Weight

374 Technical Notes

Type G AF-P DX lens with built-in CPU and F
mount
18–55 mm
f/3.5–5.6
12 elements in 9 groups (2 aspherical lens
elements)
76° – 28° 50´
Graduated in millimeters (18, 24, 35, 45, 55)
Output to camera
Manual zoom using independent zoom ring
Autofocus controlled by stepping motor;
separate focus ring for manual focus
Lens shift using voice coil motors (VCMs)
0.25 m (0.9 ft) from focal plane (0 96) at all
zoom positions
7 (rounded diaphragm opening)
Fully automatic
• 18 mm focal length: f/3.5–22
• 55 mm focal length: f/5.6–38
The minimum aperture displayed may vary
depending on the size of the exposure
increment selected with the camera.
Full aperture
55 mm (P = 0.75 mm)
Approx. 64.5 mm maximum diameter ×
62.5 mm (distance from camera lens mount
flange when lens is retracted)
Approx. 205 g (7.3 oz)

AF-P DX NIKKOR 70–300mm f/4.5–6.3G ED VR
and AF-P DX NIKKOR 70–300mm f/4.5–6.3G ED
These lenses are for use exclusively with DX format Nikon digital
SLR cameras; SLR film cameras and D4-series, D3-series, D2series, D1-series, D800-series, D700, D610, D600, D300-series,
D200, D100, D90, D80, D70-series, D60, D50, D40-series, D7000,
D5100, D5000, D3200, D3100, D3000 digital SLR cameras are not
supported. When using it with a D5500, D5300, or D3300, be
sure the camera firmware has been updated to the latest
version. The parts of the lens are listed below.

1 Lens cap

6 Focal length mark

2 Lens hood mounting mark

7 Lens mounting mark.................... 30

3 Focus ring........................................ 95

8 CPU contacts................................307

4 Zoom ring ....................................... 49

9 Rear lens cap

5 Focal length scale

Technical Notes 375

❚❚ Focus
The focus mode can be selected using camera controls (0 82).
Autofocus and rangefinder features are supported at all focal
lengths. When using this lens, ignore any sections of the camera
manual listing autofocus and rangefinder restrictions for lenses
with a maximum aperture slower than f/5.6.
Autofocus
Focus is adjusted automatically when the camera is in autofocus
mode (0 82). The focus ring can also be used to focus the
camera if the shutter-release button is kept pressed halfway (or
if the AF-ON button is kept pressed); this is known as “autofocus
with manual override” (M/A). Autofocus will resume when the
shutter-release button is pressed halfway (or the AF-ON button
is pressed) a second time. Note that touching the focus ring
while autofocus is in effect will change the focus position.
Manual Focus
When the camera is in manual focus mode, focus can be
adjusted by rotating the lens focus ring (0 95). When the
camera is off or the standby timer has expired, the focus ring can
not be used to focus and rotating the zoom ring will change the
focus position; before focusing, turn the camera on or press the
shutter-release button to reactivate the standby timer.
Users of D5, D810-series, Df, D750, D7200, D7100, and D5200
cameras should note that if the standby timer is allowed to
expire, the focus position will change when the timer is
restarted. Refocus before shooting. Longer standby times are
recommended for manual focus and in other situations in which
you may not release the shutter immediately after focusing.

376 Technical Notes

❚❚ Vibration Reduction (VR, AF-P DX NIKKOR 70–300 mm f/4.5–6.3G ED
VR Only)
When an AF-P DX NIKKOR 70–300 mm f/4.5–6.3G ED VR is
mounted on the camera, vibration reduction can be enabled or
disabled using the Optical VR option in the shooting menu
(0 232). If On is selected, vibration reduction will take effect
whenever the shutter-release button is pressed halfway.
Vibration reduction reduces blur caused by camera shake,
allowing shutter speeds up to 4.0 stops slower than would
otherwise be the case, increasing the range of shutter speeds
available. The effects of VR on shutter speed are measured
according to Camera and Imaging Products Association (CIPA)
standards; FX-format lenses are measured using FX-format
digital SLR cameras, DX-format lenses using DX-format cameras.
Zoom lenses are measured at maximum zoom.

D Vibration Reduction
• When using vibration reduction, press the shutter-release button
halfway and wait for the image in the viewfinder to stabilize before
pressing the shutter-release button the rest of the way down.
• When vibration reduction is active, the image in the viewfinder may
jiggle after the shutter is released. This does not indicate a
malfunction.
• When the camera is panned, vibration reduction applies only to
motion that is not part of the pan (if the camera is panned
horizontally, for example, vibration reduction will be applied only to
vertical shake), making it much easier to pan the camera smoothly in
a wide arc.
• If the camera is equipped with a built-in flash, vibration reduction will
be disabled while the flash charges.
• Vibration reduction is generally recommended when the camera is
mounted on a tripod, although you may prefer to turn it off
depending on shooting conditions and the type of tripod.
• Vibration reduction is recommended when the camera is mounted
on a monopod.

Technical Notes 377

❚❚ Supplied Accessories
• LC-58 58 mm Snap-on Front Lens Cap
• Rear Lens Cap

❚❚ Compatible Accessories
•
•
•
•

58 mm screw-on filters
LF-4 Rear Lens Cap
CL-1020 Lens Case
HB-77 Bayonet Hood
Align the lens hood mounting mark (●) with the lens hood
alignment mark ( ) as shown in Figure q and then rotate
the hood (w) until the ● mark is aligned with the lens hood
lock mark (—).

When attaching or removing the hood, hold it near the
symbol on its base and avoid gripping it too tightly.
Vignetting may occur if the hood is not correctly attached.
The hood can be reversed and mounted on the lens when not
in use. When the hood is reversed, it can be attached and
removed by rotating it while holding it near the lock mark
(—).

378 Technical Notes

❚❚ Specifications
Type
Focal length
Maximum aperture
Lens construction
Angle of view
Focal length scale
Distance information
Zoom
Focusing

Type G AF-P DX lens with built-in CPU and F
mount
70–300 mm
f/4.5–6.3
14 elements in 10 groups (including 1 ED lens
element)
22° 50´ – 5° 20´
Graduated in millimeters (70, 100, 135, 200, 300)
Output to camera
Manual zoom using independent zoom ring
Autofocus controlled by stepping motor;
separate focus ring for manual focus
Lens shift using voice coil motors (VCMs)

Vibration reduction
(AF-P DX NIKKOR
70–300mm f/4.5–6.3G ED
VR only)
Minimum focus distance 1.1 m (3.7 ft) from focal plane (0 96) at all zoom
positions
Diaphragm blades
7 (rounded diaphragm opening)
Diaphragm
Fully automatic
Aperture range
• 70 mm focal length: f/4.5–22
• 300 mm focal length: f/6.3–32
The minimum aperture displayed may vary
depending on the size of the exposure
increment selected with the camera.
Metering
Full aperture
Filter-attachment size
58 mm (P = 0.75 mm)
Dimensions
Approx. 72 mm maximum diameter × 125 mm
(distance from camera lens mount flange)
Weight
• AF-P DX NIKKOR 70–300mm f/4.5–6.3G ED VR:
Approx. 415 g (14.7 oz)
• AF-P DX NIKKOR 70–300mm f/4.5–6.3G ED:
Approx. 400 g (14.2 oz)

Technical Notes 379

AF-S DX NIKKOR 18–140mm f/3.5–5.6G ED VR
This lens is for use exclusively with DX format Nikon digital
camera. The parts of the lens are listed below.

11

12

1 Lens cap

8 Rubber lens-mount gasket

2 Lens hood mounting mark

9 CPU contacts................................307

3 Zoom ring ....................................... 49 10 A-M mode switch....................31, 95
4 Focal length scale
5 Focal length mark

11 Vibration reduction ON/OFF
switch ...........................................382

6 Focus ring........................................ 95 12 Rear lens cap
7 Lens mounting mark.................... 30

❚❚ Focus
Focus mode is determined by the camera focus mode and the
position of the lens A-M mode switch (0 82, 95).

A Focusing with AF-S DX NIKKOR 18–140mm f/3.5–5.6G ED VR Lenses
When single-servo AF (AF-S) is selected as the camera focus mode and
the lens A-M switch is set to A, focus can be adjusted by keeping the
shutter-release button pressed halfway after the autofocus operation
is complete and manually rotating the focus ring. To refocus using
autofocus, press the shutter-release button halfway again.

380 Technical Notes

❚❚ Using the Built-in Flash
When using the built-in flash, be sure the subject is at a range of
at least 0.6 m (2 ft) and remove lens hoods to prevent vignetting
(shadows created where the end of the lens obscures the built-in
flash).

Shadow

Vignetting

When the lens is mounted on the following cameras, the built-in
flash may be unable to light the entire subject at ranges less than
those given below:
Camera
D7200/D7100/D7000/
D300 series/D200/D100
D90/D80/D50
D5600/D5500/D5300/D5200/
D5100/D5000/D3400/D3300/
D3200/D3100/D3000/D70 series/
D60/D40 series

Zoom position
18 mm
24–140 mm
18 mm
24 mm
35–140 mm
18 mm
24 mm
35–140 mm

Minimum distance
without vignetting
1.0 m/3 ft 3 in.
No vignetting
2.5 m/8 ft 2 in.
1.0 m/3 ft 3 in.
No vignetting
1.0 m/3 ft 3 in.
No vignetting

Technical Notes 381

❚❚ Vibration Reduction (VR)
Vibration reduction can be enabled by sliding the
vibration reduction switch to ON and takes effect
whenever the shutter-release button is pressed
halfway. Vibration reduction reduces blur caused
by camera shake, allowing shutter speeds up to 4.0
stops slower than would otherwise be the case (as measured at
140 mm with a D300s camera according to Camera and Imaging
Products Association [CIPA] standards; effects vary with the
photographer and shooting conditions). This increases the
range of shutter speeds available.

D Vibration Reduction
• When using vibration reduction, press the shutter-release button
halfway and wait for the image in the viewfinder to stabilize before
pressing the shutter-release button the rest of the way down.
• When vibration reduction is active, the image in the viewfinder may
jiggle after the shutter is released. This does not indicate a
malfunction.
• When the camera is panned, vibration reduction applies only to
motion that is not part of the pan (if the camera is panned
horizontally, for example, vibration reduction will be applied only to
vertical shake), making it much easier to pan the camera smoothly in
a wide arc.
• Do not turn the camera off or remove the lens while vibration
reduction is in effect. If power to the lens is cut while vibration
reduction is on, the lens may rattle when shaken. This is not a
malfunction, and can be corrected by reattaching the lens and
turning the camera on.
• If the camera is equipped with a built-in flash, vibration reduction will
be disabled while the flash charges.
• Select OFF when the camera is mounted on a tripod unless the tripod
head is unsecured or the camera is mounted on a monopod, in which
case ON is recommended.

382 Technical Notes

❚❚ Supplied Accessories
• LC-67 67 mm Snap-on Front Lens Cap
• Rear Lens Cap

❚❚ Compatible Accessories
•
•
•
•

67 mm screw-on filters
LF-4 Rear Lens Cap
CL-1018 Flexible Lens Pouch
HB-32 Bayonet Hood
Align the lens hood mounting mark (●) with the lens hood
alignment mark ( ) as shown in Figure q and then rotate
the hood (w) until the ● mark is aligned with the lens hood
lock mark (—).

When attaching or removing the hood, hold it near the
symbol on its base and avoid gripping it too tightly.
Vignetting may occur if the hood is not correctly attached.
The hood can be reversed and mounted on the lens when not
in use.

Technical Notes 383

❚❚ Specifications
Type
Focal length
Maximum aperture
Lens construction
Angle of view
Focal length scale
Distance information
Zoom
Focusing

Vibration reduction
Minimum focus distance
Diaphragm blades
Diaphragm
Aperture range

Metering
Filter-attachment size
Dimensions
Weight

Type G AF-S DX lens with built-in CPU and F
mount
18–140 mm
f/3.5–5.6
17 elements in 12 groups (including 1 ED lens
element, 1 aspherical lens element)
76° – 11° 30 ´
Graduated in millimeters (18, 24, 35, 50, 70, 140)
Output to camera
Manual zoom using independent zoom ring
Nikon Internal Focusing (IF) System with
autofocus controlled by Silent Wave Motor and
separate focus ring for manual focus
Lens shift using voice coil motors (VCMs)
0.45 m (1.48 ft) from focal plane (0 96) at all
zoom positions
7 (rounded diaphragm opening)
Fully automatic
• 18 mm focal length: f/3.5–22
• 140 mm focal length: f/5.6–38
The minimum aperture displayed may vary
depending on the size of the exposure
increment selected with the camera.
Full aperture
67 mm (P = 0.75 mm)
Approx. 78 mm maximum diameter × 97 mm
(distance from camera lens mount flange)
Approx. 490 g (17.3 oz)

Nikon reserves the right to change the appearance and specifications of the hardware and
software described in this manual at any time and without prior notice. Nikon will not be held
liable for damages that may result from any mistakes that this manual may contain.

384 Technical Notes

D Lens Care
• Keep the CPU contacts clean.
• Should the rubber lens-mount gasket be damaged, cease use
immediately and take the lens to a Nikon-authorized service center
for repair.
• Use a blower to remove dust and lint from the lens surfaces. To
remove smudges and fingerprints, apply a small amount of ethanol
or lens cleaner to a soft, clean cotton cloth or lens-cleaning tissue and
clean from the center outwards using a circular motion, taking care
not to leave smears or touch the glass with your fingers.
• Never use organic solvents such as paint thinner or benzene to clean
the lens.
• The lens hood or Neutral Color (NC) filters can be used to protect the
front lens element.
• Attach the front and rear caps before placing the lens in its case.
• When a lens hood is attached, do not pick up or hold the lens or
camera using only the hood.
• If the lens will not be used for an extended period, store it in a cool,
dry location to prevent mold and rust. Do not store in direct sunlight
or with naphtha or camphor moth balls.
• Keep the lens dry. Rusting of the internal mechanism can cause
irreparable damage.
• Leaving the lens in extremely hot locations could damage or warp
parts made from reinforced plastic.

Technical Notes 385

A A Note on Wide- and Super Wide-Angle Lenses
Autofocus may not provide the desired results in situations like those
shown below.
1 Objects in the background occupy more of the focus point than the main subject:
If the focus point contains both
foreground and background objects,
the camera may focus on the
background and the subject may be
out of focus, particularly with wideand super wide-angle lenses.
Example: A far-off portrait
subject at some distance from
the background
2 The subject contains many fine details.
The camera may have difficulty
focusing on subjects that contain
many fine details.

Example: A field of flowers
In these cases, use manual focus, or use focus lock to focus on another
subject at the same distance and then recompose the photograph. For
more information, see “Getting Good Results with Autofocus” (0 86).

386 Technical Notes

Memory Card Capacity
The following table shows the approximate number of pictures
that can be stored on a 16 GB SanDisk Extreme Pro 95 MB/s
SDHC UHS-I card at different image quality and size settings.
Image quality
NEF (RAW),
Compressed, 14-bit
NEF (RAW),
Compressed, 12-bit

Image size

File size 1

No. of
images 1

Buffer
capacity 2

—

26.3 MB

428

11

—

21.3 MB

511

17

Large
13.4 MB
929
100
Medium
8.0 MB
1500
100
Small
4.1 MB
2900
100
Large
6.8 MB
1800
100
JPEG normal
Medium
4.1 MB
3000
100
Small
2.1 MB
5600
100
Large
2.6 MB
3500
100
JPEG basic
Medium
1.9 MB
5700
100
Small
1.2 MB
10,300
100
1 All figures are approximate. Results will vary with card type, camera settings, and scene
recorded.
2 Maximum number of exposures that can be stored in memory buffer at ISO 100. Drops when
long exposure noise reduction (0 230), auto distortion control (0 232), or Date stamp
(0 243) is on.
JPEG fine

Technical Notes 387

Battery Life
The movie footage or number of shots that can be recorded with
fully-charged batteries varies with the condition of the battery,
temperature, the interval between shots, and the length of time
menus are displayed. Sample figures for EN-EL14a (1230 mAh)
batteries are given below.
• Photographs, single-frame release mode (CIPA standard 1):
Approximately 970 shots
• Movies: Approximately 70 minutes at 1080/60p 2
1 Measured at 23 °C/73.4 °F (±2 °C/3.6 °F) with an AF-P DX NIKKOR 18–55mm
f/3.5–5.6G VR lens under the following test conditions: lens cycled from infinity
to minimum range and one photograph taken at default settings once every
30 s; after photograph is taken, monitor is turned on; tester waits for monitor to
turn off; flash fired at full power once every other shot. Live view not used.
2 Measured at 23°C/73.4°F (±2 °C/3.6 °F) with the camera at default settings and
an AF-P DX NIKKOR 18–55mm f/3.5–5.6G VR lens under conditions specified by
the Camera and Imaging Products Association (CIPA). Individual movies can be
up to 20 minutes in length or 4 GB in size; recording may end before these limits
are reached if the camera temperature rises.

388 Technical Notes

The following can reduce battery life:
• Using the monitor
• Keeping the shutter-release button pressed halfway
• Repeated autofocus operations
• Taking NEF (RAW) photographs
• Slow shutter speeds
• Using camera Wi-Fi (wireless LAN) and Bluetooth features
• Using the camera with optional accessories connected
• Using VR (vibration reduction) mode with VR lenses
• Repeatedly zooming in and out with an AF-P lens.
To ensure that you get the most from rechargeable Nikon
EN-EL14a batteries:
• Keep the battery contacts clean. Soiled contacts can reduce
battery performance.
• Use batteries immediately after charging. Batteries will lose
their charge if left unused.

Technical Notes 389

Index
Symbols
i (Auto mode) ............................... 4, 47
j (Auto (flash off) mode)............ 4, 47
h (Scene)................................... 4, 58
k (Portrait) ............................................59
l (Landscape)......................................59
p (Child).................................................59
m (Sports)...............................................60
n (Close up)..........................................60
o (Night portrait)................................60
r (Night landscape)...........................61
s (Party/indoor)..................................61
t (Beach/snow)...................................61
u (Sunset)..............................................62
v (Dusk/dawn) ....................................62
w (Pet portrait) ....................................62
x (Candlelight)......................................63
y (Blossom)...........................................63
z (Autumn colors)..............................63
0 (Food) ..................................................64
q (Special effects) .................. 4, 65
% (Night vision) ...................................65
S (Super vivid) .....................................66
T (Pop) ..................................................66
U (Photo illustration)..................66, 70
' (Toy camera effect) .................67, 71
( (Miniature effect) ....................67, 72
3 (Selective color) .......................67, 73
1 (Silhouette).......................................68
2 (High key)..........................................68
3 (Low key)...........................................68
P (Programmed auto) ........4, 118, 119
S (Shutter-priority auto) ....4, 118, 121
A (Aperture-priority auto).4, 118, 122
M (Manual) .............................4, 118, 123
U (flexible program) ........................ 120
8 (Single frame) .................................75

390 Technical Notes

! (Continuous L)...................... 75, 76
9 (Continuous H) ..................... 75, 76
E (Self-timer) ................................ 75, 79
J (Quiet shutter release) ......... 75, 78
c (Single-point AF).......................... 87
d (Dynamic-area AF)....................... 87
e (Auto-area AF)............................... 88
f (3D-tracking) ................................. 88
6 (Face-priority AF)........................... 89
7 (Wide-area AF) ................................ 89
8 (Normal-area AF) ........................... 89
9 (Subject-tracking AF) ................. 90
L (Matrix metering) ........................128
M (Center-weighted metering)...128
N (Spot metering)............................128
o (auto flash)..............................102
j (red-eye reduction)..........102, 104
p (slow sync).....................102, 104
q (rear-curtain sync) ...............104
Y (Flash compensation)...............134
E (Exposure compensation) ........132
e (AE bracketing) ....................151
f (WB bracketing) .................151
g (ADL bracketing) ...............151
d (Help) ................................................. 43
m (White balance) ...........................140
L (Preset manual)..........................145
I (focus indicator)............... 50, 93, 96
N (flash-ready indicator) .... 5, 54, 318
a (live view)................................ 47, 164
t (memory buffer) ....................77, 387
P button...............................12, 166, 187
R button........................................ 6, 115

Numerics
2016-pixel RGB sensor 247, 307, 358,
360
3D color matrix metering ..............307

3D-tracking (AF-area mode)............88

A
AC adapter.................................321, 325
Access lamp...........................................51
Accessories ......................................... 321
Accessory terminal accessories... 324
Active D-Lighting ............................. 136
Add items (My Menu) ..................... 301
ADL bracketing (Auto bracketing set)
151
Adobe RGB.......................................... 230
AE bracketing (Auto bracketing set) .
151
AE lock.................................................. 130
AE-L ....................................................... 130
AE-L/AF-L button..................94, 130, 254
AF .............................................82–94, 235
AF area brackets ...........................41, 49
AF-A..........................................................82
AF-area mode .......................................87
AF-assist illuminator........85, 237, 310
AF-C................................................ 82, 235
AF-F ..........................................................83
AF-S ...................................................82, 83
Airplane mode................................... 271
A-M mode switch ...................... 95, 380
Angle of view..................................... 314
Aperture ........................... 118, 122, 124
Aperture-priority auto.................... 122
Assign AE-L/AF-L button ............... 254
Assign Fn button .............................. 252
Assign touch Fn ................................ 255
Auto (White balance)...................... 140
Auto bracketing.......................151, 251
Auto distortion control .................. 232
Auto flash ............................................ 102
Auto image rotation........................ 222
Auto info display .............................. 265
Auto ISO sensitivity control.......... 228
Auto off timers .................................. 240

Auto-area AF (AF-area mode) ........ 88
Autoexposure lock ...........................130
Autofocus ............................. 82–94, 235
Auto-servo AF ...................................... 82
Available settings .............................338

B
Battery .......................... 26, 27, 321, 364
Beep options ......................................263
Black-and-white ................................290
Bluetooth.................................... xxii, 273
Body cap ......................................... 1, 323
Border (PictBridge)...........................215
Bracketing ................................. 151, 251
Built-in AF-assist illuminator.85, 237,
310
Built-in flash.............................. 101, 312
Bulb.............................................. 125, 126
Burst......................................................... 76

C
Calendar playback............................186
Camera Control Pro 2......................323
Capture NX-D .....................................210
CEC.........................................................219
Center-weighted metering ...........128
Charger................................ 26, 321, 364
Choose start/end point ..................178
Clean image sensor..........................328
Clock...............................................40, 262
Clock battery ........................................ 27
Cloudy (White balance) ..................140
CLS .........................................................315
Color outline.......................................293
Color sketch ........................................294
Color space .........................................230
Color temperature............................142
Commander mode...........................247
Compatible lenses............................305
Conformity marking .............. 276, 367
Connect to smart device................271

Technical Notes 391

Continuous (Release mode).....75, 76
Continuous-servo AF ............... 82, 235
Copyright ................................... 193, 261
CPU contacts...................................... 307
CPU lens............................................... 305
Creative Lighting System .............. 315
Cropping (PictBridge)..................... 215
Cross screen (Filter effects)........... 289
Custom Settings ............................... 233
Cyanotype .......................................... 290

D
Date and time.................................... 262
Date counter............................. 243, 244
Date format ................................. 40, 262
Date stamp ......................................... 243
Daylight saving time................ 40, 262
DCF version 2.0 ................................. 365
Delete................................................... 205
Delete all images.............................. 206
Delete current image...................... 205
Delete selected images.................. 206
Device control (HDMI).................... 219
Diopter adjustment control .. 41, 322
Direct sunlight (White balance) .. 140
Distortion control.................... 232, 287
D-Lighting........................................... 285
Dynamic-area AF.................................87

E
Edit movie.................................. 178, 182
Electronic rangefinder............. 96, 237
EV steps for exposure cntrl ........... 239
Exif version 2.3 .................................. 365
Exposure............................128, 130, 132
Exposure bracketing....................... 151
Exposure compensation................ 132
Exposure delay mode..................... 241
Exposure indicator.................... 11, 124
Exposure lock .................................... 130
Exposure meters..................................53

392 Technical Notes

Exposure mode .................................118
Exposure smoothing ..............111, 173
External microphone..............170, 323
Eye sensor ...................................... 8, 265
Eye-Fi upload .....................................274

F
Face-priority AF................................... 89
Face zoom ...........................................199
File information.................................189
File naming .........................................227
File number sequence ....................242
Filter effects ..................... 158, 160, 289
Filters.....................................................321
Fine-tuning white balance............143
Firmware version ..............................276
Fisheye..................................................288
Flash ......................................54, 101, 315
Flash (White balance)......................140
Flash cntrl for built-in flash ...........246
Flash compensation ........................134
Flash control.......................................247
Flash mode ................................102, 104
Flash range..........................................106
Flash ready indicator........... 5, 54, 318
Flash sync speed......................106, 357
Flat (Set Picture Control)................155
Flexible program ..............................120
Flicker reduction ......................167, 268
Fluorescent (White balance)140, 141
Fn button..............................................252
f-number..............................................122
Focal length........................................314
Focal length scale.......... 369, 375, 380
Focal plane mark................................. 96
Focus................................................ 82–97
Focus indicator...................... 50, 93, 96
Focus lock.............................................. 93
Focus mode .......................................... 82
Focus point ...... 50, 87, 90, 93, 96, 236
Focusing screen ................................357

Focus-mode switch .....................31, 95
Format memory card ...................... 259
Frame interval (Slide show) .......... 209
Frame size/frame rate..................... 168
Framing grid ..................................9, 243
Front-curtain sync............................ 104
Full-frame playback......................... 184
Full-time-servo AF...............................83

i-TTL balanced fill-flash for digital
SLR.............................................. 247, 315

G

L

GPS device .......................................... 269

Landscape (Set Picture Control)..155
Language.............................................262
Large (Image size).............................100
Lens....................................... 30, 305, 369
Lens focus ring.........95, 369, 375, 380
Lens mount................................1, 30, 96
Lens vibration reduction switch... 32,
382
Live view .......................................47, 164
Location data ........................... 195, 269
Lock mirror up for cleaning...........330
Long exposure NR ............................230
Low-angle shots.................................. 13

H
H.264..................................................... 361
HDMI............................................218, 365
HDMI-CEC............................................ 219
HDR (high dynamic range) ........... 138
Help..........................................................43
High definition .........................218, 365
High Dynamic Range (HDR) ......... 138
High ISO NR ........................................ 231
High-angle shots .................................13
Highlights...................................189, 221
Histogram ..................................190, 221

I
Image comment ............................... 260
Image Dust Off ref photo .............. 266
Image overlay .................................... 291
Image quality........................................98
Image review ..................................... 221
Image size ........................................... 100
Incandescent (White balance)..... 140
Info display auto off ....................8, 265
Info display format........................... 264
In-focus indicator ..................50, 93, 96
Information display .....................6, 264
Interval timer shooting .................. 109
ISO display .......................................... 239
ISO sensitivity ...........................107, 228
i-TTL..............................................246, 247

J
JPEG ......................................................... 98
JPEG basic.............................................. 98
JPEG fine ................................................ 98
JPEG normal.......................................... 98

M
Manage Picture Control .................161
Manual...........................................95, 123
Manual focus ................................. 83, 95
Manual focus ring in AF mode.....238
Manual movie settings ...................169
Matrix metering.................................128
Maximum sensitivity .......................228
Medium (Image size) .......................100
Memory buffer..................................... 77
Memory card ............27, 259, 324, 387
Memory card capacity ....................387
Metering ..............................................128
Microphone ........................................169
Miniature effect ..........................72, 295
Minimum shutter speed.................228
Mired .....................................................144

Technical Notes 393

Mirror................................................1, 330
Mode dial ................................................. 4
Monitor ................................13, 184, 263
Monitor brightness.......................... 263
Monochrome..................................... 290
Monochrome (Set Picture Control) ...
155
Mounting mark........30, 369, 375, 380
Movie quality..................................... 168
Movie settings................................... 168
Movie-record button ...................... 165
Movies.................................................. 164
My Menu ............................................. 301

N
NEF (RAW)........................... 98, 227, 280
NEF (RAW) processing.................... 280
NEF (RAW) recording ...................... 227
Neutral (Set Picture Control)........ 155
Nikon Transfer 2 ............................... 212
No. of copies (PictBridge).............. 215
Non-CPU lens..................................... 308
Normal-area AF....................................89
Number of exposures remaining ..46
Number of focus points................. 236
Number of shots............................... 388

O
Optical VR ........................................... 232
Optional flash .................................... 315
Output resolution (HDMI)............. 219
Overview data ................................... 194

P
Page size (PictBridge) ..................... 215
Painting ............................................... 298
Perspective control ......................... 288
Photo Illustration ...................... 70, 294
Photo information ..................188, 221
PictBridge................................... 214, 365
Picture Controls ....................... 155, 157

394 Technical Notes

Playback...............................................184
Playback display options ...............221
Playback folder..................................221
Playback information .............188, 221
Playback menu ..................................220
Playback zoom ..................................196
Portrait (Set Picture Control) ........155
Power connector .....................321, 325
Preset manual (White balance) .. 140,
145
Press the shutter-release button all
the way down ............................. 51, 52
Press the shutter-release button
halfway .......................................... 50, 52
Print date (PictBridge).....................215
Print select ..........................................216
Printing.................................................214
Programmed auto............................119
Protecting photographs ................200

Q
Quick retouch ....................................286
Quiet shutter release.................. 75, 78

R
Rangefinder ........................................237
Rank items (My Menu) ....................304
Rating...........................................201, 209
Rear-curtain sync ..............................104
Recent settings..................................300
Red-eye correction...........................286
Red-eye reduction...................102, 104
Release mode....................................... 75
Remote control.........................270, 323
Remote cord..............................125, 324
Remote shutter release ..................270
Remove items (My Menu)..............303
Reset................................... 115, 225, 235
Reset custom settings.....................235
Reset shooting menu......................225
Resize ....................................................283

Retouch menu................................... 277
Retractable lens barrel button.31, 32
Reverse dial rotation ....................... 256
Reverse indicators............................ 245
RGB ...............................................190, 230
RGB histogram .................................. 190
Rotate tall............................................ 222

S
Save selected frame ........................ 182
Scene auto selector ............................52
Scene mode ..........................................58
Select to send to smart device .... 204
Select to send to smart device/
deselect.............................................. 203
Selective color ............................ 73, 296
Self-portrait ...........................................13
Self-timer............................... 75, 79, 241
Send to smart device (auto) ......... 272
Sensitivity...................................107, 228
Sepia ..................................................... 290
Set Picture Control........................... 157
Setup menu........................................ 257
Shade (White balance) ................... 140
Shooting data.................................... 192
Shooting menu ................................. 223
Shutter speed ................. 118, 121, 123
Shutter-priority auto ....................... 121
Shutter-release button.......51, 52, 93,
130, 239
Shutter-release button AE-L......... 239
Side-by-side comparison............... 298
Single frame (Release mode) ..........75
Single-point AF (AF-area mode) ....87
Single-servo AF .............................82, 83
Size ..................................... 100, 168, 282
Skylight (Filter effects).................... 289
Slide show........................................... 208
Slot empty release lock .................. 268
Slow sync....................................102, 104
Small (Image size) ............................ 100

SnapBridge......................................... i, 33
Soft (Filter effects) ............................289
Special effects mode ......................... 65
Speedlight...........................................315
Spot metering....................................128
sRGB.......................................................230
Standard (Set Picture Control) .....155
Standard i-TTL fill-flash for digital
SLR.............................................. 247, 315
Standby timer .............................53, 240
Start printing (PictBridge).... 216, 217
Storage folder ....................................225
Straighten............................................287
Subject-tracking AF ........................... 90
Sync with smart device...................262

T
Television.............................................218
Thumbnail playback ........................185
Time............................................. 125, 127
Time zone .....................................40, 262
Time zone and date ..................40, 262
Time-lapse movie .............................171
Timer ..............................................79, 109
Toning......................................... 158, 160
Touch controls.................. 15, 160, 263
Touch screen ........................................ 15
Touch shutter....................................... 19
Trim.............................................. 198, 282
Trimming movies..............................178
Type D lens..........................................307
Type E lens ..........................................307
Type G lens..........................................307

U
USB cable..........................211, 214, 324

V
Vari-angle monitor ............................. 13
Vibration reduction32, 232, 372, 377,
382

Technical Notes 395

Viewfinder ............................... 5, 41, 357
Viewfinder eyepiece cap ..................80
Viewfinder grid display .................. 243
ViewNX-i.............................................. 210
Vignette control ............................... 231
Vivid (Set Picture Control)............. 155
Volume........................................ 177, 208

W
Warm filter (Filter effects).............. 289
WB.......................................................... 140
WB bracketing (Auto bracketing set)
151
White balance ................................... 140
Wide-area AF ........................................89
Wi-Fi ..............................................xxii, 272
Wind noise reduction ..................... 169
Wireless................................................. xxii
Wireless remote controller .. 270, 324

396 Technical Notes

No reproduction in any form of this manual, in whole or in part (except
for brief quotation in critical articles or reviews), may be made without
written authorization from NIKON CORPORATION.

SB6I01(11)

6MB36711-01



Source Exif Data:
File Type                       : PDF
File Type Extension             : pdf
MIME Type                       : application/pdf
PDF Version                     : 1.4
Linearized                      : Yes
Encryption                      : Standard V2.3 (128-bit)
User Access                     : Print, Extract
Has XFA                         : No
XMP Toolkit                     : Adobe XMP Core 4.2.1-c041 52.342996, 2008/05/07-20:48:00
Producer                        : Acrobat Distiller 9.0.0 (Windows)
Create Date                     : 2016:09:15 15:03:37Z
Creator Tool                    : FrameMaker 12.0.4
Modify Date                     : 2016:09:23 19:18:04+09:00
Metadata Date                   : 2016:09:23 19:18:04+09:00
Document ID                     : uuid:ac3aef06-1b3d-434c-b55c-50ef785b69c3
Instance ID                     : uuid:8c44c4e9-4523-40bd-8e99-cf0950ef117f
Format                          : application/pdf
Creator                         : Nikon Corporation
Title                           : 
Page Layout                     : SinglePage
Page Mode                       : UseOutlines
Page Count                      : 424
Author                          : Nikon Corporation
EXIF Metadata provided by EXIF.tools

Navigation menu